blob: 7555af375f7a51a5c5bfe1512a39c24fa7219752 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall2d887082010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregore737f502010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000041
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +000059 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
60 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
61 // emit them now.
62 llvm::DenseMap<Decl *, llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 1> >::iterator
63 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
64 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
65 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
66 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
67 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
68
69 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
70 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't remove this
71 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
72 // diagnostics again.
73 Suppressed.clear();
74 }
75 }
76
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000077 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000078 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
79 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, DA->getMessage(), Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000080
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000081 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc784dc12010-10-06 23:12:32 +000082 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
83 if (UA->getMessage().empty())
84 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
85 else
86 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000087 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage();
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000088 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
89 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000090
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000091 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000092 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000093 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
94 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
95 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
96 return true;
97 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000098 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000099
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +0000100 // Warn if this is used but marked unused.
101 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
102 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName();
103
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000104 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +0000105}
106
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000107/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000108/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000109/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
110///
111void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000112 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +0000113 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000114 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000115 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +0000116
117 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
118 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000119 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
120 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000121
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000122 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
123 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000124 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000125 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
126 int isMethod = 0;
127 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
128 // skip over named parameters.
129 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
130 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
131 if (nullPos)
132 --nullPos;
133 else
134 ++i;
135 }
136 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
137 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000138 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000139 // skip over named parameters.
140 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
141 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
142 if (nullPos)
143 --nullPos;
144 else
145 ++i;
146 }
147 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000148 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000149 // block or function pointer call.
150 QualType Ty = V->getType();
151 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000152 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000153 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
154 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000155 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
156 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
157 unsigned k;
158 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
159 if (nullPos)
160 --nullPos;
161 else
162 ++i;
163 }
164 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
165 }
166 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
167 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000168 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000169 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000170 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000171 return;
172
173 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000174 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000175 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000176 return;
177 }
178 int sentinel = i;
179 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
180 --sentinelPos;
181 ++i;
182 }
183 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
184 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000185 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000186 return;
187 }
188 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
189 ++i;
190 ++sentinel;
191 }
192 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000193 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
194 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
195 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Anders Carlsson343e6ff2010-11-05 15:21:33 +0000196
197 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
198 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return;
199
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000200 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000201 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
202 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
203 return;
204
205 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
206 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
207
208 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
209 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000210}
211
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000212SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
213 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
214 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
215}
216
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000217//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
218// Standard Promotions and Conversions
219//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
220
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000221/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
222void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
223 QualType Ty = E->getType();
224 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
225
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000226 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000227 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000228 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000229 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
230 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
231 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
232 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
233 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
234 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
235 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000236 //
237 // C++ 4.2p1:
238 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
239 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
240 //
241 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
242 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000243 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000244 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000245 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000246}
247
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000248void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
249 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000250
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000251 QualType Ty = E->getType();
252 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
253 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
254 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
255 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
256 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
257 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
258 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
259 // rvalue is T
260 //
261 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000262 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
263 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000264 // type of the lvalue.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000265 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000266 }
267}
268
269
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000270/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000271/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000272/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
273/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
274/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
275Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
276 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
277 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000278
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000279 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
280 //
281 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
282 // unsigned int may be used:
283 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
284 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
285 // and unsigned int.
286 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
287 //
288 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
289 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
290 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
291 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000292 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
293 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000294 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000295 return Expr;
296 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000297 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000298 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000299 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000300 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000301 }
302
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000303 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000304 return Expr;
305}
306
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000307/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000308/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000309/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
310void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
311 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
312 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000313
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000314 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000315 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
316 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000317 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000318
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000319 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
320}
321
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000322/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
323/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
324/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
325/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000326bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
327 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000328 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000329
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000330 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
331 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
332 // etc.
333 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
334 return false;
335
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000336 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000337 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
338 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
339 << Expr->getType() << CT))
340 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000341
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000342 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000343 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000344 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
345 << Expr->getType() << CT))
346 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000347
348 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000349}
350
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000351/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
352/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000353/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000354/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
355/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
356/// GCC.
357QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
358 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000359 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000360 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000361
362 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000363
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000364 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000365 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000366 QualType lhs =
367 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000368 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000369 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000370
371 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
372 if (lhs == rhs)
373 return lhs;
374
375 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
376 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
377 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
378 return lhs;
379
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000380 // Apply unary and bitfield promotions to the LHS's type.
381 QualType lhs_unpromoted = lhs;
382 if (lhs->isPromotableIntegerType())
383 lhs = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(lhs);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000384 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000385 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
386 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000387 if (lhs != lhs_unpromoted && !isCompAssign)
388 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000389
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000390 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
391 if (lhs == rhs)
392 return lhs;
393
394 // At this point, we have two different arithmetic types.
395
396 // Handle complex types first (C99 6.3.1.8p1).
397 bool LHSComplexFloat = lhs->isComplexType();
398 bool RHSComplexFloat = rhs->isComplexType();
399 if (LHSComplexFloat || RHSComplexFloat) {
400 // if we have an integer operand, the result is the complex type.
401
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000402 if (!RHSComplexFloat && !rhs->isRealFloatingType()) {
403 if (rhs->isIntegerType()) {
404 QualType fp = cast<ComplexType>(lhs)->getElementType();
405 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, fp, CK_IntegralToFloating);
406 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
407 } else {
408 assert(rhs->isComplexIntegerType());
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +0000409 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000410 }
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000411 return lhs;
412 }
413
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000414 if (!LHSComplexFloat && !lhs->isRealFloatingType()) {
415 if (!isCompAssign) {
416 // int -> float -> _Complex float
417 if (lhs->isIntegerType()) {
418 QualType fp = cast<ComplexType>(rhs)->getElementType();
419 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, fp, CK_IntegralToFloating);
420 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
421 } else {
422 assert(lhs->isComplexIntegerType());
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +0000423 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000424 }
425 }
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000426 return rhs;
427 }
428
429 // This handles complex/complex, complex/float, or float/complex.
430 // When both operands are complex, the shorter operand is converted to the
431 // type of the longer, and that is the type of the result. This corresponds
432 // to what is done when combining two real floating-point operands.
433 // The fun begins when size promotion occur across type domains.
434 // From H&S 6.3.4: When one operand is complex and the other is a real
435 // floating-point type, the less precise type is converted, within it's
436 // real or complex domain, to the precision of the other type. For example,
437 // when combining a "long double" with a "double _Complex", the
438 // "double _Complex" is promoted to "long double _Complex".
439 int order = Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(lhs, rhs);
440
441 // If both are complex, just cast to the more precise type.
442 if (LHSComplexFloat && RHSComplexFloat) {
443 if (order > 0) {
444 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000445 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000446 return lhs;
447
448 } else if (order < 0) {
449 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
450 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000451 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000452 return rhs;
453 }
454 return lhs;
455 }
456
457 // If just the LHS is complex, the RHS needs to be converted,
458 // and the LHS might need to be promoted.
459 if (LHSComplexFloat) {
460 if (order > 0) { // LHS is wider
461 // float -> _Complex double
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000462 QualType fp = cast<ComplexType>(lhs)->getElementType();
463 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, fp, CK_FloatingCast);
464 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000465 return lhs;
466 }
467
468 // RHS is at least as wide. Find its corresponding complex type.
469 QualType result = (order == 0 ? lhs : Context.getComplexType(rhs));
470
471 // double -> _Complex double
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000472 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000473
474 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
475 if (!isCompAssign && order < 0)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000476 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000477
478 return result;
479 }
480
481 // Just the RHS is complex, so the LHS needs to be converted
482 // and the RHS might need to be promoted.
483 assert(RHSComplexFloat);
484
485 if (order < 0) { // RHS is wider
486 // float -> _Complex double
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000487 if (!isCompAssign) {
488 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingCast);
489 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
490 }
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000491 return rhs;
492 }
493
494 // LHS is at least as wide. Find its corresponding complex type.
495 QualType result = (order == 0 ? rhs : Context.getComplexType(lhs));
496
497 // double -> _Complex double
498 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000499 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000500
501 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
502 if (order > 0)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000503 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000504
505 return result;
506 }
507
508 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double).
509 bool LHSFloat = lhs->isRealFloatingType();
510 bool RHSFloat = rhs->isRealFloatingType();
511 if (LHSFloat || RHSFloat) {
512 // If we have two real floating types, convert the smaller operand
513 // to the bigger result.
514 if (LHSFloat && RHSFloat) {
515 int order = Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(lhs, rhs);
516 if (order > 0) {
517 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_FloatingCast);
518 return lhs;
519 }
520
521 assert(order < 0 && "illegal float comparison");
522 if (!isCompAssign)
523 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingCast);
524 return rhs;
525 }
526
527 // If we have an integer operand, the result is the real floating type.
528 if (LHSFloat) {
529 if (rhs->isIntegerType()) {
530 // Convert rhs to the lhs floating point type.
531 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralToFloating);
532 return lhs;
533 }
534
535 // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float.
536 assert(rhs->isComplexIntegerType());
537 QualType result = Context.getComplexType(lhs);
538
539 // _Complex int -> _Complex float
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +0000540 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000541
542 // float -> _Complex float
543 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000544 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000545
546 return result;
547 }
548
549 assert(RHSFloat);
550 if (lhs->isIntegerType()) {
551 // Convert lhs to the rhs floating point type.
552 if (!isCompAssign)
553 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralToFloating);
554 return rhs;
555 }
556
557 // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float.
558 assert(lhs->isComplexIntegerType());
559 QualType result = Context.getComplexType(rhs);
560
561 // _Complex int -> _Complex float
562 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +0000563 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000564
565 // float -> _Complex float
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000566 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000567
568 return result;
569 }
570
571 // Handle GCC complex int extension.
572 // FIXME: if the operands are (int, _Complex long), we currently
573 // don't promote the complex. Also, signedness?
574 const ComplexType *lhsComplexInt = lhs->getAsComplexIntegerType();
575 const ComplexType *rhsComplexInt = rhs->getAsComplexIntegerType();
576 if (lhsComplexInt && rhsComplexInt) {
577 int order = Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(lhsComplexInt->getElementType(),
578 rhsComplexInt->getElementType());
579 assert(order && "inequal types with equal element ordering");
580 if (order > 0) {
581 // _Complex int -> _Complex long
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000582 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000583 return lhs;
584 }
585
586 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000587 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000588 return rhs;
589 } else if (lhsComplexInt) {
590 // int -> _Complex int
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000591 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000592 return lhs;
593 } else if (rhsComplexInt) {
594 // int -> _Complex int
595 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000596 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000597 return rhs;
598 }
599
600 // Finally, we have two differing integer types.
601 // The rules for this case are in C99 6.3.1.8
602 int compare = Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(lhs, rhs);
603 bool lhsSigned = lhs->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(),
604 rhsSigned = rhs->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
605 if (lhsSigned == rhsSigned) {
606 // Same signedness; use the higher-ranked type
607 if (compare >= 0) {
608 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralCast);
609 return lhs;
610 } else if (!isCompAssign)
611 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralCast);
612 return rhs;
613 } else if (compare != (lhsSigned ? 1 : -1)) {
614 // The unsigned type has greater than or equal rank to the
615 // signed type, so use the unsigned type
616 if (rhsSigned) {
617 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralCast);
618 return lhs;
619 } else if (!isCompAssign)
620 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralCast);
621 return rhs;
622 } else if (Context.getIntWidth(lhs) != Context.getIntWidth(rhs)) {
623 // The two types are different widths; if we are here, that
624 // means the signed type is larger than the unsigned type, so
625 // use the signed type.
626 if (lhsSigned) {
627 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralCast);
628 return lhs;
629 } else if (!isCompAssign)
630 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralCast);
631 return rhs;
632 } else {
633 // The signed type is higher-ranked than the unsigned type,
634 // but isn't actually any bigger (like unsigned int and long
635 // on most 32-bit systems). Use the unsigned type corresponding
636 // to the signed type.
637 QualType result =
638 Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhsSigned ? lhs : rhs);
639 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_IntegralCast);
640 if (!isCompAssign)
641 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_IntegralCast);
642 return result;
643 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000644}
645
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000646//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
647// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
648//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
649
650
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000651/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000652/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
653/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
654/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
655/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000656///
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000657ExprResult
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000658Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000659 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
660
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000661 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000662 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000663 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000664
665 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
666 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
667 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000668
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000669 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000670 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000671 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000672
673 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000674 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000675 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000676
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000677 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
678 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
679 // strings.
680 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000681 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000682 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000683
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000684 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000685 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
686 Literal.GetStringLength(),
687 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
688 &StringTokLocs[0],
689 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000690}
691
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000692/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
693/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
694/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
695/// for values inside the block or for globals).
696///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000697/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000698/// up-to-date.
699///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000700static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000701 ValueDecl *VD) {
702 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
703 // we wanted to.
704 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
705 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000706
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000707 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
708 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
709 return false;
710
711 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
712 // snapshot it.
713 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
714 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000715 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
716 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000717
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000718 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
719 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
720
721 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
722 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
723 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
724 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000725 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
726 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000727
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000728 if (!NextBlock)
729 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000730
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000731 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
732 // having a reference outside it.
733 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
734 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000735
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000736 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
737 // a snapshot as well.
738 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
739 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000740
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000741 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000742}
743
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000744
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000745ExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000746Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000747 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000748 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
749 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
750}
751
752/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000753ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000754Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
755 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
756 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000757 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000758 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000759 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000760 << D->getDeclName();
761 return ExprError();
762 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000763
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000764 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000765 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
766 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
767 // visible.
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000768 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000769 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000770 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
771 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000772 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
773 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000774 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000775 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000776 << D->getIdentifier();
777 return ExprError();
778 }
779 }
780 }
781 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000782
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000783 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000784
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000785 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
786 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
787 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000788 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000789}
790
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000791/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
792/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
793/// actual member.
794///
795/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
796/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
797/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
798/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
799/// we found.
800///
801/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
802/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
803/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
804VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
805 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000806 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
807 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
808 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
809
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000810 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000811 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
812 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
813 do {
814 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000815 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000816 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000817 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000818 else {
819 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
820 break;
821 }
822 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000823 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000824 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000825
826 return BaseObject;
827}
828
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000829ExprResult
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000830Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
831 FieldDecl *Field,
832 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
833 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
834 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000835 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000836 AnonFields);
837
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000838 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
839 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
840 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
841 // found via name lookup.
842 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000843 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000844 if (BaseObject) {
845 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
846 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000847 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000848 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Devang Patela2c21a22010-10-12 23:23:25 +0000849 Loc);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000850 BaseQuals
851 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000852 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
853 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
854 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
855 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
856 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000857 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000858 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
859 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
860 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000861 BaseQuals
862 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000863 } else {
864 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
865 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
866 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000867 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
868 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000869 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000870 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000871 = Context.getTagDeclType(
872 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
873 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000874 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000875 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
876 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
877 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000878 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000879 MD->getThisType(Context),
880 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000881 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
882 }
883 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000884 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
885 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000886 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000887 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000888 }
889
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000890 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000891 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
892 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000893 }
894
895 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
896 // anonymous struct/union.
897 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000898 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000899 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
900 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
901 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
902 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000903 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
904 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
905
906 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
907 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
908 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
909 ResultQuals.removeConst();
910
911 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
912 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
913
914 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
915 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
916
917 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
918 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
919 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
920
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000921 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000922 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000923 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000924 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
925 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000926 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000927 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000928 }
929
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000930 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000931}
932
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000933/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000934/// possibly a list of template arguments.
935///
936/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
937/// DecomposeTemplateName.
938///
939/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
940/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
941/// some way.
942static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
943 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
944 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000945 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000946 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
947 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
948 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
949 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
950
951 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
952 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
953 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
954 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
955 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
956
John McCall2b5289b2010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000957 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000958 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
959 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000960 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
961 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000962 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000963 TemplateArgs = 0;
964 }
965}
966
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000967/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
968/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
969/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000970static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000971 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
972 return false;
973
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000974 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
975 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
976 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
977 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
978 if (!BaseRT) return false;
979
980 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000981 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000982 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
983 return false;
984 }
985
986 return true;
987}
988
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000989/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
990/// the prospective base classes.
991static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
992 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
993 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000994 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000995 return false;
996
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000997 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000998 if (!RD) return false;
999 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
1000
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001001 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
1002 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
1003 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
1004 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
1005 if (!BaseRT) return false;
1006
1007 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001008 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
1009 return false;
1010 }
1011
1012 return true;
1013}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001014
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001015enum IMAKind {
1016 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
1017 IMA_Static,
1018
1019 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
1020 IMA_Mixed,
1021
1022 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
1023 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
1024 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
1025
1026 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
1027 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
1028 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
1029
1030 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
1031 IMA_Instance,
1032
1033 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
1034 IMA_Unresolved,
1035
1036 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
1037 /// context is not an instance method.
1038 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
1039
1040 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
1041 /// non-class context.
1042 IMA_AnonymousMember,
1043
1044 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
1045 /// context is not an instance method.
1046 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
1047
1048 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
1049 /// class.
1050 IMA_Error_Unrelated
1051};
1052
1053/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
1054/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
1055/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
1056/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
1057/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
1058/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
1059static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
1060 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001061 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001062
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001063 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001064 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001065 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
1066 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001067
1068 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1069 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
1070
1071 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
1072 bool hasNonInstance = false;
1073 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
1074 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001075 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1076 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001077 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
1078
1079 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
1080 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
1081 // that's a special case.
1082 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
1083 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
1084 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
1085 }
1086 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
1087 }
1088 else
1089 hasNonInstance = true;
1090 }
1091
1092 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
1093 // member reference.
1094 if (Classes.empty())
1095 return IMA_Static;
1096
1097 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
1098 // an implicit member reference.
1099 if (isStaticContext)
1100 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
1101
1102 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
1103 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
1104 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
1105 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001106 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001107 Classes))
1108 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
1109
1110 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
1111}
1112
1113/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
1114static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
1115 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1116 const LookupResult &R) {
1117 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1118 SourceRange Range(Loc);
1119 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
1120
1121 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
1122 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
1123 if (MD->isStatic()) {
1124 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
1125 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
1126 << Range << R.getLookupName();
1127 return;
1128 }
1129 }
1130
1131 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
1132 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
1133 return;
1134 }
1135
1136 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001137}
1138
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001139/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
1140///
1141/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001142bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
1143 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001144 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
1145
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001146 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001147 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001148 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
1149 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001150 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001151 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001152 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
1153 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001154
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001155 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
1156 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
1157 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
1158 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001159 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001160 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001161 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
1162 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1163
1164 if (!R.empty()) {
1165 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
1166 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1167
1168 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
1169 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
1170 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
1171 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
1172
1173 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
1174 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
1175 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001176 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001177 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
1178 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001179 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001180 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +00001181 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001182 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
1183 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
1184 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
1185 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
1186 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
1187 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
1188 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
1189 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
1190 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
1191 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
1192 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
1193 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
1194 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
1195 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +00001196 } else {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001197 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
1198 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
1199 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +00001200 }
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001201 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001202 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001203 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001204
1205 // Do we really want to note all of these?
1206 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
1207 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
1208
1209 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
1210 return false;
1211 }
Douglas Gregore26f0432010-08-09 22:38:14 +00001212
1213 R.clear();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001214 }
1215 }
1216
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001217 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001218 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +00001219 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001220 if (!R.empty()) {
1221 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
1222 if (SS.isEmpty())
1223 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
1224 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
1225 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
1226 else
1227 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1228 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
1229 << SS.getRange()
1230 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
1231 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
1232 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
1233 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
1234 << ND->getDeclName();
1235
1236 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
1237 return false;
1238 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001239
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001240 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
1241 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
1242 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
1243 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
1244 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
1245 // to recover well anyway.
1246 if (SS.isEmpty())
1247 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
1248 else
1249 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1250 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
1251 << SS.getRange();
1252
1253 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
1254 return true;
1255 }
1256 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001257 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001258 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001259 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001260 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001261 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001262 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001263 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1264 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001265 return true;
1266 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001267 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001268 }
1269
1270 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1271 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1272 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1273 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1274 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1275 << SS.getRange();
1276 return true;
1277 }
1278
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001279 // Give up, we can't recover.
1280 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1281 return true;
1282}
1283
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001284ObjCPropertyDecl *Sema::canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(IdentifierInfo *II) {
1285 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001286 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1287 if (!IDecl)
1288 return 0;
1289 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1290 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1291 return 0;
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001292 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001293 if (!property)
1294 return 0;
1295 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001296 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic ||
1297 PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001298 return 0;
1299 return property;
1300}
1301
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001302bool Sema::canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(ObjCPropertyDecl *Property) {
1303 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = getCurMethodDecl();
1304 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1305 if (!IDecl)
1306 return false;
1307 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1308 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1309 return false;
1310 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl
1311 = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(Property->getIdentifier()))
1312 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic ||
1313 PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1314 return false;
1315
1316 return true;
1317}
1318
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001319static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001320 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001321 IdentifierInfo *II,
1322 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1323 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001324 bool LookForIvars;
1325 if (Lookup.empty())
1326 LookForIvars = true;
1327 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1328 LookForIvars = false;
1329 else
1330 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1331 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1332 if (!LookForIvars)
1333 return 0;
1334
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001335 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1336 if (!IDecl)
1337 return 0;
1338 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001339 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1340 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001341 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1342 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1343 if (!property)
1344 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian43e1b462010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001345 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II)) {
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001346 DynamicImplSeen =
1347 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
Fariborz Jahanian43e1b462010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001348 // property implementation has a designated ivar. No need to assume a new
1349 // one.
1350 if (!DynamicImplSeen && PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1351 return 0;
1352 }
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001353 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001354 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1355 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001356 NameLoc,
1357 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1358 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1359 (Expr *)0, true);
1360 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1361 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1362 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1363 return Ivar;
1364 }
1365 return 0;
1366}
1367
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001368ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001369 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1370 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1371 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1372 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001373 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1374 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1375
1376 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001377 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001378
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001379 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001380
1381 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001382 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001383 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001384 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001385
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001386 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001387 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001388 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001389
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001390 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1391 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001392 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1393 // (note: handled after lookup)
1394 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1395 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1396 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001397 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1398 // names a dependent type.
1399 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1400 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001401 bool DependentID = false;
1402 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1403 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1404 DependentID = true;
1405 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1406 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1407 if (DC) {
1408 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1409 return ExprError();
1410 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1411 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1412 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1413 } else {
1414 DependentID = true;
1415 }
1416 }
1417
1418 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001419 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001420 TemplateArgs);
1421 }
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001422 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001423 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001424 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001425 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001426 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1427 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1428 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1429 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1430 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001431 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1432 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1433 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001434 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001435 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001436 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001437
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001438 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1439 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001440 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001441 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001442 if (E.isInvalid())
1443 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001444
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001445 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1446 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001447 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1448 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001449 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001450 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1451 isAddressOfOperand);
1452 }
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001453 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1454 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001455 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001456 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001457
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001458 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1459 return ExprError();
1460
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001461 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1462 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001463 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001464
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001465 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001466 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001467 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1468 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1469 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1470 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1471 }
1472
1473 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1474 // call, diagnose the problem.
1475 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001476 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001477 return ExprError();
1478
1479 assert(!R.empty() &&
1480 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001481
1482 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1483 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001484 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001485 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1486 R.clear();
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001487 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001488 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1489 return move(E);
1490 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001491 }
1492 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001493
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001494 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1495 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1496
1497 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001498 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianb1d58e32010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001499 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1500 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001501 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property = canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(II);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001502 if (Property) {
1503 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1504 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001505 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001506 }
1507 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001508 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001509 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1510 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1511 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1512 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1513 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1514 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001515 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001516 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001517
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001518 QualType T = Func->getType();
1519 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001520 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001521 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1522 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001523 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001524 }
1525 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001526
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001527 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001528 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1529 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1530 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1531 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1532 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1533 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1534 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1535 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001536 //
1537 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1538 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1539 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1540 // non-static member function:
1541 //
1542 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1543 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1544 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1545 // member function call.
1546 //
1547 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1548 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1549 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1550 // instance method.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001551 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001552 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1553 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1554 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1555 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1556 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1557 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1558 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregore2248be2010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001559 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1560 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001561 else
1562 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1563
1564 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001565 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001566 }
1567
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001568 if (TemplateArgs)
1569 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001570
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001571 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1572}
1573
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001574/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001575ExprResult
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001576Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1577 LookupResult &R,
1578 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1579 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1580 case IMA_Instance:
1581 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1582
1583 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1584 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1585 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1586 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1587
1588 case IMA_Mixed:
1589 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1590 case IMA_Unresolved:
1591 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1592
1593 case IMA_Static:
1594 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1595 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1596 if (TemplateArgs)
1597 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1598 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1599
1600 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1601 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1602 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1603 return ExprError();
1604 }
1605
1606 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1607 return ExprError();
1608}
1609
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001610/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1611/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1612/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1613/// this path.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001614ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001615Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001616 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001617 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001618 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001619 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001620
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001621 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001622 return ExprError();
1623
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001624 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001625 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1626
1627 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1628 return ExprError();
1629
1630 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001631 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1632 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001633 return ExprError();
1634 }
1635
1636 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1637}
1638
1639/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1640/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1641/// additional lookup.
1642///
1643/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1644/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1645///
1646/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001647ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001648Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001649 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001650 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001651 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001652
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001653 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1654 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1655 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1656 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1657 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1658
1659 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1660 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1661 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001662 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001663
1664 bool LookForIvars;
1665 if (Lookup.empty())
1666 LookForIvars = true;
1667 else if (IsClassMethod)
1668 LookForIvars = false;
1669 else
1670 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1671 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001672 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001673 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001674 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001675 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1676 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1677 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1678 if (IsClassMethod)
1679 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1680 << IV->getDeclName());
1681
1682 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1683 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1684 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1685 return ExprError();
1686
1687 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1688 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1689 return ExprError();
1690
1691 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1692 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1693 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1694 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1695
1696 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1697 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1698 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1699 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001700 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001701 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001702 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregore45bb6a2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001703 SelfName, false, false);
1704 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1705 return ExprError();
1706
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001707 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1708 return Owned(new (Context)
1709 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1710 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1711 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001712 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001713 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001714 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001715 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1716 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1717 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1718 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1719 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1720 }
1721 }
1722
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001723 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1724 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1725 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1726 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1727 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1728 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1729 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1730 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1731 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1732 }
1733 }
1734 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001735 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1736 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001737}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001738
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001739/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1740///
1741/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1742///
1743/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1744/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1745/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1746/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1747///
1748/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1749/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1750/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1751/// the class declaring the member.
1752///
1753/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1754/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1755/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001756bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001757Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1758 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001759 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001760 NamedDecl *Member) {
1761 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1762 if (!RD)
1763 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001764
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001765 QualType DestRecordType;
1766 QualType DestType;
1767 QualType FromRecordType;
1768 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1769 bool PointerConversions = false;
1770 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1771 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001772
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001773 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1774 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1775 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1776 PointerConversions = true;
1777 } else {
1778 DestType = DestRecordType;
1779 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001780 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001781 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1782 if (Method->isStatic())
1783 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001784
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001785 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1786 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001787
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001788 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1789 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1790 PointerConversions = true;
1791 } else {
1792 FromRecordType = FromType;
1793 DestType = DestRecordType;
1794 }
1795 } else {
1796 // No conversion necessary.
1797 return false;
1798 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001799
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001800 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1801 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001802
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001803 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1804 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1805 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001806
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001807 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1808 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1809
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001810 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001811
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001812 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001813 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001814 // class name.
1815 //
1816 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1817 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1818 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1819 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1820 //
1821 // class Base { public: int x; };
1822 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1823 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1824 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1825 //
1826 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1827 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1828 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1829 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001830 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001831 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1832 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1833 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1834
1835 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1836
1837 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1838 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1839 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1840 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001841 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001842 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001843 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001844 return true;
1845
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001846 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001847 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001848 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1849 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001850
1851 FromType = QType;
1852 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1853
1854 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1855 // we're done.
1856 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1857 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001858 }
1859 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001860
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001861 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001862
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001863 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1864 // down to the using declaration's type.
1865 //
1866 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1867 // class ever has member declarations.
1868 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1869 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1870 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1871 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1872
1873 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1874 // conversion is non-trivial.
1875 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1876 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001877 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001878 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001879 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001880 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001881
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001882 QualType UType = URecordType;
1883 if (PointerConversions)
1884 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001885 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001886 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001887 FromType = UType;
1888 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1889 }
1890
1891 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1892 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1893 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001894 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001895
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001896 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001897 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1898 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001899 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001900 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001901
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001902 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001903 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001904 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001905}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001906
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001907/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001908static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001909 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001910 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001911 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1912 QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001913 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1914 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1915 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001916 if (SS.isSet()) {
1917 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1918 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001919 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001920
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001921 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001922 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1923 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001924}
1925
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001926/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1927/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1928/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1929/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001930ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001931Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1932 LookupResult &R,
1933 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1934 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001935 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1936
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001937 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001938
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001939 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1940 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001941 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001942 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001943 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001944 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001945 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001946
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001947 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1948 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001949 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1950 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001951 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1952 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001953 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1954 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1955 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1956 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001957 }
1958
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001959 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001960 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1961 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001962 SS,
1963 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1964 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001965}
1966
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001967bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001968 const LookupResult &R,
1969 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001970 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1971 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1972 return false;
1973
1974 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001975 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001976 return false;
1977
1978 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001979 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001980 return false;
1981
1982 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1983 // normal lookup:
1984 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1985 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1986
1987 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1988 // -- a declaration of a class member
1989 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1990 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001991 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001992 return false;
1993
1994 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1995 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1996 // using-declaration
1997 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1998 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1999 // turn off ADL anyway).
2000 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2001 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2002 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
2003 return false;
2004
2005 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2006 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
2007 // template
2008 // And also for builtin functions.
2009 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2010 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
2011
2012 // But also builtin functions.
2013 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
2014 return false;
2015 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
2016 return false;
2017 }
2018
2019 return true;
2020}
2021
2022
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002023/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
2024/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
2025/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
2026/// will in fact be used.
2027static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
2028 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
2029 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
2030 return true;
2031 }
2032
2033 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
2034 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
2035 return true;
2036 }
2037
2038 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
2039 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
2040 return true;
2041 }
2042
2043 return false;
2044}
2045
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002046ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002047Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00002048 LookupResult &R,
2049 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00002050 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
2051 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00002052 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002053 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
2054 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002055
2056 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
2057 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
2058 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00002059 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
2060 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002061 return ExprError();
2062
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002063 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
2064 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
2065 // we've picked a target.
2066 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2067
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002068 bool Dependent
2069 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002070 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002071 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002072 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002073 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002074 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
2075 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002076
2077 return Owned(ULE);
2078}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002079
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002080
2081/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002082ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002083Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002084 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
2085 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002086 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00002087 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
2088 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002089
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002090 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002091 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
2092 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002093
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00002094 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
2095 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
2096 // a template argument list.
2097 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
2098 << Template << SS.getRange();
2099 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
2100 return ExprError();
2101 }
2102
2103 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
2104 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
2105 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002106 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00002107 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00002108 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00002109 return ExprError();
2110 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002111
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00002112 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
2113 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
2114 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
2115 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002116 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00002117 return ExprError();
2118
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00002119 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
2120 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002121 return ExprError();
2122
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00002123 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
2124 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
2125 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
2126 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00002127 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00002128 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
2129 // as they do not get snapshotted.
2130 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002131 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00002132 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00002133 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
2134 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
2135 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
2136 return ExprError();
2137 }
2138
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00002139 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00002140 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
2141 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
2142 return ExprError();
2143 }
2144
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00002145 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00002146 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00002147 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Fariborz Jahaniane2204552010-11-16 19:29:39 +00002148 bool byrefVar = (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>() != 0);
Fariborz Jahanian52bc56a2010-07-12 17:26:57 +00002149 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane2204552010-11-16 19:29:39 +00002150 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE;
2151
2152 if (!byrefVar) {
2153 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
2154 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
2155 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
2156 ExprTy.addConst();
2157 BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, false,
2158 constAdded);
2159 }
2160 else
2161 BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true);
2162
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00002163 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2164 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
2165 Expr *E = new (Context)
2166 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
2167 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9d62010-11-11 00:11:38 +00002168 if (T->getAs<RecordType>())
2169 if (!T->isUnionType()) {
2170 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00002171 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00002172 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00002173 SourceLocation(),
2174 Owned(E));
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9d62010-11-11 00:11:38 +00002175 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
2176 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
2177 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
2178 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
2179 }
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00002180 }
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00002181 }
2182 }
2183 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00002184 }
2185 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
2186 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002187
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002188 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
2189 NameInfo, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002190}
2191
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002192ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002193 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00002194 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002195
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002196 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00002197 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00002198 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
2199 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
2200 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002201 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00002202
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00002203 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
2204 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002205
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00002206 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanianeb024ac2010-07-23 21:53:24 +00002207 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
2208 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00002209 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00002210 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00002211 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00002212 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002213
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00002214 QualType ResTy;
2215 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
2216 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
2217 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00002218 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002219
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00002220 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002221 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00002222 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
2223 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002224 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002225}
2226
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002227ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002228 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00002229 bool Invalid = false;
2230 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
2231 if (Invalid)
2232 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002233
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00002234 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
2235 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002236 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002237 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00002238
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00002239 QualType Ty;
2240 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
2241 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
2242 else if (Literal.isWide())
2243 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00002244 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
2245 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00002246 else
2247 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00002248
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00002249 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
2250 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00002251 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002252}
2253
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002254ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002255 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002256 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
2257 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00002258 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00002259 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002260 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00002261 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002262 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00002263
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002264 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00002265 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
2266 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002267 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002268
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002269 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00002270 bool Invalid = false;
2271 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
2272 if (Invalid)
2273 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002274
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002275 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002276 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
2277 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002278 return ExprError();
2279
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002280 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002281
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002282 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002283 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002284 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002285 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002286 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002287 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002288 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00002289 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002290
2291 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
2292
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002293 using llvm::APFloat;
2294 APFloat Val(Format);
2295
2296 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00002297
2298 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
2299 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
2300 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
2301 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002302 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002303 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002304 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002305 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002306 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2307 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002308 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002309 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2310 }
2311
2312 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2313 << Ty
2314 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2315 }
2316
2317 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002318 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002319
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002320 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002321 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002322 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002323 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002324
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002325 // long long is a C99 feature.
2326 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002327 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002328 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2329
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002330 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002331 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002332
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002333 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2334 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2335 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002336 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2337 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002338 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002339 } else {
2340 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2341 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002342
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002343 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2344 // be an unsigned int.
2345 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2346
2347 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002348 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002349 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2350 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002351 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002352
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002353 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2354 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2355 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2356 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002357 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002358 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002359 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002360 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002361 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002362 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002363
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002364 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002365 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002366 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002367
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002368 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2369 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2370 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2371 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002372 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002373 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002374 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002375 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002376 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002377 }
2378
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002379 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002380 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002381 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002382
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002383 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2384 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2385 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2386 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002387 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002388 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002389 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002390 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002391 }
2392 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002393
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002394 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2395 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002396 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002397 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002398 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002399 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002400 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002401
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002402 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2403 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002404 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002405 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002406 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002407
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002408 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2409 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002410 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002411 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002412
2413 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002414}
2415
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002416ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002417 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002418 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002419 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002420}
2421
2422/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2423/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002424bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002425 SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002426 SourceRange ExprRange,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002427 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002428 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2429 return false;
2430
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002431 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2432 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2433 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2434 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2435 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2436 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2437
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002438 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002439 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002440 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002441 if (isSizeof)
2442 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2443 return false;
2444 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002445
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002446 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002447 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002448 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2449 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002450 return false;
2451 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002452
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002453 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002454 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2455 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002456 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002457
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002458 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002459 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002460 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002461 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2462 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002463 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002464
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002465 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002466}
2467
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002468static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2469 SourceRange ExprRange) {
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002470 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002471
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002472 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002473 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2474 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002475
2476 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2477 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2478 return false;
2479
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002480 if (E->getBitField()) {
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002481 S. Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002482 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002483 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002484
2485 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2486 // bit-field.
2487 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002488 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002489 return false;
2490
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002491 return S.CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002492}
2493
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002494/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002495ExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002496Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002497 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002498 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002499 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002500 return ExprError();
2501
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002502 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002503
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002504 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2505 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2506 return ExprError();
2507
2508 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002509 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002510 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2511 R.getEnd()));
2512}
2513
2514/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2515/// operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002516ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002517Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002518 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2519 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2520 bool isInvalid = false;
2521 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2522 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2523 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002524 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002525 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002526 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2527 isInvalid = true;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002528 } else if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
2529 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E, OpLoc);
2530 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2531 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(PE.take(), OpLoc, isSizeOf, R);
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002532 } else {
2533 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2534 }
2535
2536 if (isInvalid)
2537 return ExprError();
2538
2539 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2540 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2541 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2542 R.getEnd()));
2543}
2544
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002545/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2546/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2547/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002548ExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002549Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2550 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002551 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002552 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002553
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002554 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002555 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002556 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002557 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002558 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002559
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002560 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002561 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002562 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2563
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002564 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002565}
2566
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002567QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002568 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2569 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002570
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002571 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002572 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002573 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002574
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002575 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2576 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2577 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002578
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002579 // Test for placeholders.
2580 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(V, Loc);
2581 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
2582 if (PR.take() != V) {
2583 V = PR.take();
2584 return CheckRealImagOperand(V, Loc, isReal);
2585 }
2586
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002587 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002588 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2589 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002590 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002591}
2592
2593
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002594
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002595ExprResult
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002596Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002597 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002598 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002599 switch (Kind) {
2600 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002601 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2602 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002603 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002604
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002605 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002606}
2607
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002608ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002609Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2610 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002611 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002612 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002613 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2614 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002615
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002616 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002617
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002618 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002619 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002620 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2621 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2622 }
2623
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002624 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002625 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002626 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2627 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2628 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002629 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002630 }
2631
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002632 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002633}
2634
2635
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002636ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002637Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2638 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2639 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2640 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002641
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002642 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002643 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2644 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2645 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002646
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002647 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002648
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002649 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002650 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002651 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002652 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002653 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2654 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002655 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2656 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2657 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2658 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002659 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002660 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2661 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002662 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002663 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002664 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002665 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2666 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002667 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002668 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002669 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002670 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2671 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2672 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002673 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002674 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002675 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2676 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2677 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2678 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002679 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002680 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002681 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002682
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002683 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2684 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002685 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2686 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002687 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002688 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2689 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2690 // force the promotion here.
2691 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2692 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002693 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002694 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002695 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2696
2697 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2698 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002699 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002700 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2701 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2702 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2703 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002704 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002705 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002706 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2707
2708 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2709 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002710 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002711 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002712 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2713 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002714 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002715 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002716 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002717 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2718 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002719
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002720 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002721 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2722 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002723 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2724
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002725 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002726 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2727 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002728 // incomplete types are not object types.
2729 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2730 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2731 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2732 return ExprError();
2733 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002734
Abramo Bagnara46358452010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002735 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2736 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2737 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2738 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2739 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002740 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002741 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2742 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002743 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002744
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002745 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002746 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002747 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2748 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2749 return ExprError();
2750 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002751
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002752 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002753 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002754}
2755
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002756QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002757CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002758 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002759 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002760 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2761 // see FIXME there.
2762 //
2763 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2764 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002765 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002766
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002767 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002768 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002769
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002770 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002771 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2772 // to be selected.
2773 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002774
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002775 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2776 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002777 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002778
2779 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2780 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002781 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002782 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2783 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002784 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002785 do
2786 compStr++;
2787 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002788 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002789 do
2790 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002791 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002792 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002793
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002794 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002795 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2796 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002797 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramer476d8b82010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002798 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002799 return QualType();
2800 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002801
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002802 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2803 // operates on.
2804 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002805 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002806
2807 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002808 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002809
2810 while (*compStr) {
2811 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2812 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2813 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2814 return QualType();
2815 }
2816 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002817 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002818
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002819 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002820 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002821 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002822 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002823 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002824 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002825 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002826 if (HexSwizzle)
2827 CompSize--;
2828
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002829 if (CompSize == 1)
2830 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002831
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002832 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002833 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002834 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2835 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2836 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2837 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002838 }
2839 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002840}
2841
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002842static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002843 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002844 const Selector &Sel,
2845 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002846 if (Member)
2847 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
2848 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002849 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002850 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002851
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002852 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2853 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002854 if (Decl *D = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2855 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002856 return D;
2857 }
2858 return 0;
2859}
2860
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002861static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
2862 IdentifierInfo *Member,
2863 const Selector &Sel,
2864 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002865 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2866 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002867 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002868 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002869 if (Member)
2870 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
2871 GDecl = PD;
2872 break;
2873 }
2874 // Also must look for a getter or setter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002875 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002876 GDecl = OMD;
2877 break;
2878 }
2879 }
2880 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002881 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002882 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2883 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002884 GDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2885 Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002886 if (GDecl)
2887 return GDecl;
2888 }
2889 }
2890 return GDecl;
2891}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002892
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002893ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002894Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002895 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002896 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2897 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002898 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002899 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002900 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2901 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2902 //
2903 // T* t;
2904 // t.f;
2905 //
2906 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2907 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2908 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2909 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002910 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002911 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2912 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002913 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002914 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002915 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002916 return ExprError();
2917 }
2918 }
2919
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002920 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2921 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002922 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002923
2924 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2925 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002926 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002927 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002928 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002929 SS.getRange(),
2930 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002931 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002932}
2933
2934/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2935/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2936/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2937static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2938 Expr *BaseExpr,
2939 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002940 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002941 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002942 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2943 // diagnostics.
2944 if (!BaseExpr)
2945 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002946
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002947 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2948 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002949}
2950
2951// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2952// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2953// type. The restriction here is:
2954//
2955// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2956// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2957// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2958//
2959// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2960// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2961// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2962// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2963bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2964 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002965 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002966 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002967 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2968 if (!BaseRT) {
2969 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2970 // dependent.
2971 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2972 return false;
2973 }
2974 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002975
2976 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002977 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2978 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002979 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002980 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002981
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002982 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002983 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2984 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2985 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002986
Douglas Gregor9d4bb942010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002987 if (!DC->isRecord())
2988 continue;
2989
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002990 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002991 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002992
2993 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2994 return false;
2995 }
2996
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002997 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002998 return true;
2999}
3000
3001static bool
3002LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
3003 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003004 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
3005 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003006 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
3007 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00003008 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003009 << BaseRange))
3010 return true;
3011
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003012 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
3013 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
3014 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
3015
3016 bool MOUS;
3017 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
3018 return false;
3019 }
3020
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003021 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
3022 if (SS.isSet()) {
3023 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
3024 // nested-name-specifier.
3025 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
3026
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00003027 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00003028 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
3029 << SS.getRange() << DC;
3030 return true;
3031 }
3032
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003033 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003034
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003035 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
3036 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
3037 << DC << SS.getRange();
3038 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003039 }
3040 }
3041
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003042 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
3043 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003044
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00003045 if (!R.empty())
3046 return false;
3047
3048 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
3049 // for typos.
3050 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003051 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003052 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00003053 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
3054 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
3055 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003056 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3057 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003058 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
3059 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
3060 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00003061 return false;
3062 } else {
3063 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003064 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00003065 }
3066
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003067 return false;
3068}
3069
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003070ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003071Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003072 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003073 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003074 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003075 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003076 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00003077 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
3078 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003079 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003080 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3081 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003082 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003083
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003084 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003085
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003086 // Implicit member accesses.
3087 if (!Base) {
3088 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
3089 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
3090 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
3091 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003092 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003093 return ExprError();
3094
3095 // Explicit member accesses.
3096 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003097 ExprResult Result =
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003098 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003099 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003100
3101 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3102 Owned(Base);
3103 return ExprError();
3104 }
3105
3106 if (Result.get())
3107 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00003108
3109 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
3110 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003111 }
3112
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003113 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003114 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3115 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003116}
3117
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003118ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003119Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003120 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
3121 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003122 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003123 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00003124 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
3125 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003126 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003127 if (IsArrow) {
3128 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
3129 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
3130 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00003131 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003132
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003133 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003134 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
3135 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
3136 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003137
3138 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00003139 return ExprError();
3140
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003141 if (R.empty()) {
3142 // Rederive where we looked up.
3143 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
3144 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
3145 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003146
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003147 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003148 << MemberName << DC
3149 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003150 return ExprError();
3151 }
3152
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003153 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
3154 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
3155 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
3156 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
3157 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
3158 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
3159 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
3160 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
3161 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
3162 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00003163 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003164 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003165 return ExprError();
3166
3167 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
3168 // result.
3169 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003170 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00003171 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003172 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00003173 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003174
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00003175 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
3176 // pick a member.
3177 R.suppressDiagnostics();
3178
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003179 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
3180 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
3181 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003182 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
3183 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003184 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003185 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00003186 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003187
3188 return Owned(MemExpr);
3189 }
3190
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003191 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00003192 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003193 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
3194
3195 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
3196
3197 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3198 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3199 // error cases.
3200 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
3201 return ExprError();
3202
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003203 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
3204 if (!BaseExpr) {
3205 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00003206 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003207 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003208
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00003209 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
3210 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
3211 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
3212 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003213 }
3214
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003215 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
3216 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3217 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
3218 // explicitly qualified.
3219 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
3220 ShouldCheckUse = false;
3221 }
3222
3223 // Check the use of this member.
3224 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
3225 Owned(BaseExpr);
3226 return ExprError();
3227 }
3228
3229 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3230 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
3231 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00003232 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
3233 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003234 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
3235 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
3236
3237 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
3238 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
3239 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
3240 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
3241 else {
3242 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
3243 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3244 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
3245
3246 Qualifiers MemberQuals
3247 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
3248
3249 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
3250 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
3251 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
3252 }
3253
3254 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003255 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003256 return ExprError();
3257 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003258 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3259 MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003260 }
3261
3262 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3263 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
3264 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003265 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003266 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
3267 }
3268
3269 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3270 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3271 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003272 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003273 MemberFn->getType()));
3274 }
3275
3276 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3277 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3278 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003279 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3280 Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003281 }
3282
3283 Owned(BaseExpr);
3284
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003285 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003286 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003287 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003288 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
3289 else
3290 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
3291 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003292
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003293 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
3294 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003295 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003296 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003297}
3298
3299/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
3300/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
3301/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
3302/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
3303/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
3304/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
3305/// an ordinary member expression.
3306///
3307/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
3308/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003309ExprResult
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003310Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003311 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003312 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003313 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003314 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003315
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003316 // Perform default conversions.
3317 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003318
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003319 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003320 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3321
3322 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3323 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003324
3325 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003326 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003327 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3328 // call, and continue on.
3329 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3330 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3331 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3332 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3333 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003334 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3335 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003336 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3337 ->isRecordType()))) {
3338 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
Nick Lewycky3d6c45d2010-10-15 21:43:24 +00003339 Diag(BaseExpr->getExprLoc(), diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003340 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003341 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003342
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003343 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003344 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregorf918b832010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003345 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003346 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003347 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003348
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003349 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3350 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3351 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3352 }
3353 }
3354 }
3355
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003356 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3357 // use that.
3358 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003359 if (IsArrow) {
3360 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3361 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3362 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003363 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003364 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003365 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3366 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003367 }
3368 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003369 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3370 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3371 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3372 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003373 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003374 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003375 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003376
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003377 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3378 // use that.
3379 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3380 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3381 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3382 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3383 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003384 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003385 }
3386 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003387
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003388 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003389
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003390 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003391 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003392 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3393 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3394 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3395 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3396 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3397 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3398 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3399 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3400 // Check the use of this method.
3401 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3402 return ExprError();
3403 }
3404 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3405 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3406 Selector SetterSel =
3407 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3408 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3409 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3410 if (!Setter) {
3411 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3412 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003413 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003414 }
3415 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3416 if (!Setter)
3417 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003418
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003419 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3420 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003421
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003422 if (Getter || Setter) {
3423 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003424
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003425 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003426 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003427 else
3428 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3429 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3430 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003431 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003432 PType,
3433 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3434 }
3435 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3436 << MemberName << BaseType);
3437 }
3438 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003439
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003440 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3441 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3442 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003443 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003444 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003445
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003446 if (IsArrow) {
3447 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003448 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003449 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3450 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003451 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3452 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3453 // struct MyRecord foo;
3454 // foo->bar
3455 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3456 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3457 // by now.
3458 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3459 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003460 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003461 IsArrow = false;
3462 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003463 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3464 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3465 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003466 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003467 } else {
3468 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3469 // type *foo;
3470 // foo.bar
3471 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3472 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3473 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3474 // the appropriate pointer type
3475 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3476 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3477 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3478 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3479 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003480 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003481 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3482 IsArrow = true;
3483 }
3484 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003485 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003486
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003487 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003488 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003489 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003490 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003491 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003492 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003493 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003494
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003495 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3496 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003497 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003498 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003499 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003500 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3501 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3502 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3503 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003504 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3505
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003506 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003507 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003508
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003509 if (!IV) {
3510 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3511 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3512 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor9a632ea2010-10-20 03:06:34 +00003513 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false,
3514 IsArrow? CTC_ObjCIvarLookup
3515 : CTC_ObjCPropertyLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003516 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003517 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003518 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3519 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003520 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3521 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003522 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003523 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003524 } else {
3525 Res.clear();
3526 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003527 }
3528 }
3529
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003530 if (IV) {
3531 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3532 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3533 // error cases.
3534 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3535 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003536
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003537 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3538 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3539 return ExprError();
3540 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3541 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3542 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3543 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3544 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3545 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3546 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3547 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3548 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3549 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3550 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3551 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003552 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003553 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003554 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3555 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003556 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003557 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3558 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003559
3560 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3561 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003562 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003563 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003564 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003565 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3566 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003567 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003568 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003569 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003570
3571 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3572 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003573 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003574 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003575 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003576 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003577 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003578 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003579 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003580 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003581 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3582 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003583 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003584 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003585
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003586 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003587 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003588 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel,
3589 Context)) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003590 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3591 // Check the use of this declaration
3592 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3593 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003594
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003595 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003596 MemberLoc,
3597 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003598 }
3599 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3600 // Check the use of this method.
3601 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3602 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003603 Selector SetterSel =
3604 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3605 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3606 ObjCMethodDecl *SMD = 0;
3607 if (Decl *SDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, /*Property id*/0,
3608 SetterSel, Context))
3609 SMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(SDecl);
3610 QualType PType = OMD->getSendResultType();
3611 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(OMD, PType,
3612 SMD,
3613 MemberLoc,
3614 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003615 }
3616 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003617
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003618 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003619 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003620 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003621
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003622 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3623 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003624 if (!IsArrow)
3625 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3626 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003627 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc,
3628 SourceLocation(), QualType(), false);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003629
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003630 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003631 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003632 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3633 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003634 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003635 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003636 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003637
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003638 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003639 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003640 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003641 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3642 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003643 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003644 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003645 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003646 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003647
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003648 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3649 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3650
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003651 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003652}
3653
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003654/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3655/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3656/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3657/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3658/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3659///
3660/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3661/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3662/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3663/// only be called
3664/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3665/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3666/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003667ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003668 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3669 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003670 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003671 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003672 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003673 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3674 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3675 return ExprError();
3676
3677 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3678
3679 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003680 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003681 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3682 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003683 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003684
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003685 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003686 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3687
3688 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3689 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3690 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3691
3692 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003693 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003694 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3695 Base = Result.take();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003696
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003697 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3698 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003699 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003700 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3701 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003702 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003703 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003704 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003705 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3706 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003707
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003708 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3709 Owned(Base);
3710 return ExprError();
3711 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003712
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003713 if (Result.get()) {
3714 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3715 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3716 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3717 // call now.
3718 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3719 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003720 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003721
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003722 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003723 }
3724
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003725 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003726 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3727 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003728 }
3729
3730 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003731}
3732
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003733ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003734 FunctionDecl *FD,
3735 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3736 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003737 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003738 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3739 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003740 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003741 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003742 return ExprError();
3743 }
3744
3745 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3746 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003747
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003748 // Instantiate the expression.
3749 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3750 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003751
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003752 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3753 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3754 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3755 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003756
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003757 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3758 if (Result.isInvalid())
3759 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003760
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003761 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3762 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003763 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003764 InitializationKind Kind
3765 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3766 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3767 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003768
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003769 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3770 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3771 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3772 if (Result.isInvalid())
3773 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003774
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003775 // Build the default argument expression.
3776 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3777 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003778 }
3779
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003780 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3781 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3782 // be properly destroyed.
3783 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3784 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003785 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3786 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3787 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3788 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3789 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3790 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003791
3792 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003793 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3794 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003795 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003796 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003797}
3798
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003799/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3800/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3801/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3802/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3803/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3804/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003805bool
3806Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003807 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003808 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003809 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3810 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003811 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003812 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3813 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003814 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003815
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003816 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3817 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3818 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3819 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3820 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003821 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003822 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003823 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003824 }
3825
3826 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3827 // them.
3828 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3829 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3830 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3831 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003832 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003833 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003834 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3835 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3836 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003837 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003838 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003839 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003840 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003841 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003842 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003843 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3844 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3845 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3846 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3847 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003848 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003849 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003850 if (Invalid)
3851 return true;
3852 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3853 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3854 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003855
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003856 return false;
3857}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003858
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003859bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3860 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3861 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3862 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3863 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3864 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003865 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003866 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3867 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3868 bool Invalid = false;
3869 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3870 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3871 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3872 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003873 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003874 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003875 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003876
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003877 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003878 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3879 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003880
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003881 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3882 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003883 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003884 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003885 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003886
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003887 // Pass the argument
3888 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3889 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3890 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003891
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003892 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003893 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3894 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003895 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003896 SourceLocation(),
3897 Owned(Arg));
3898 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3899 return true;
3900
3901 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003902 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003903 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003904
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003905 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003906 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003907 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3908 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003909
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003910 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003911 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003912 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003913 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003914
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003915 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003916 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003917 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003918 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003919 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003920 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003921 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003922 }
3923 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003924 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003925}
3926
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003927/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003928/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3929/// locations.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003930ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003931Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003932 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003933 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003934
3935 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003936 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003937 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3938 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003939
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003940 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003941
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003942 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003943 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3944 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3945 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3946 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3947 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003948 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003949 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3950 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003951
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003952 NumArgs = 0;
3953 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003954
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003955 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3956 RParenLoc));
3957 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003958
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003959 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003960 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003961 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3962 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003963 bool Dependent = false;
3964 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3965 Dependent = true;
3966 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3967 Dependent = true;
3968
3969 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003970 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003971 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3972
3973 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3974 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3975 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003976 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003977
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003978 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3979
3980 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3981 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3982 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3983 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3984 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3985 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3986 // method template.
3987 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003988 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3989 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003990 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003991
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003992 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003993 RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003994 }
3995
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003996 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003997 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003998 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003999 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00004000 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00004001 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004002 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004003
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00004004 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00004005 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004006 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
4007 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00004008 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
4009 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00004010 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004011
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004012 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
4013 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
4014 NumArgs, ResultTy,
4015 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004016
4017 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
4018 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004019 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00004020 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00004021
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004022 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00004023 RParenLoc))
4024 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00004025
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004026 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00004027 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004028 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00004029 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4030 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00004031 }
4032 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004033 }
4034
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00004035 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004036 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00004037 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004038
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00004039 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregoref9b1492010-11-09 20:03:54 +00004040 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
4041 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
4042 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
4043 RParenLoc);
4044 }
4045
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00004046 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
Douglas Gregord8f0ade2010-10-25 20:48:33 +00004047 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn))
4048 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf)
4049 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
4050
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00004051 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
4052 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
4053
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00004054 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
4055}
4056
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00004057/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
4058/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00004059/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
4060/// block-pointer type.
4061///
4062/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004063ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00004064Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
4065 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4066 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4067 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
4068 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
4069
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00004070 // Promote the function operand.
4071 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
4072
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004073 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
4074 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004075 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
4076 Args, NumArgs,
4077 Context.BoolTy,
4078 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004079
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00004080 const FunctionType *FuncT;
4081 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
4082 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
4083 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004084 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00004085 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004086 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4087 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004088 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00004089 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004090 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004091 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00004092 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004093 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004094 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4095 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4096
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00004097 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004098 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004099 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00004100 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00004101 return ExprError();
4102
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004103 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00004104 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004105
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004106 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004107 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004108 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004109 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004110 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004111 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004112
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00004113 if (FDecl) {
4114 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
4115 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
4116 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00004117 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004118 const FunctionProtoType *Proto
4119 = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
4120 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size()))
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00004121 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
4122 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00004123 }
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004124
4125 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have
4126 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype.
4127 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype())
4128 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00004129 }
4130
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00004131 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004132 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
4133 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004134
4135 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumArgs()) {
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004136 InitializedEntity Entity
4137 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
4138 Proto->getArgType(i));
4139 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
4140 SourceLocation(),
4141 Owned(Arg));
4142 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
4143 return true;
4144
4145 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
4146
4147 } else {
4148 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004149 }
4150
Douglas Gregor0700bbf2010-10-26 05:45:40 +00004151 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4152 Arg->getType(),
4153 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
4154 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
4155 return ExprError();
4156
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004157 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00004158 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004159 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004160
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004161 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
4162 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004163 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
4164 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004165
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00004166 // Check for sentinels
4167 if (NDecl)
4168 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004169
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00004170 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00004171 if (FDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004172 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00004173 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004174
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00004175 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004176 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00004177 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004178 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00004179 return ExprError();
4180 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00004181
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004182 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004183}
4184
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004185ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004186Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004187 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004188 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00004189 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004190 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004191
4192 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
4193 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
4194 if (!TInfo)
4195 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
4196
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004197 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004198}
4199
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004200ExprResult
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004201Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004202 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004203 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00004204
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00004205 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise6fe9a22010-11-08 19:14:19 +00004206 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType),
4207 PDiag(diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type)
4208 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
4209 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
4210 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004211 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004212 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
4213 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00004214 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
4215 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00004216 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004217 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00004218 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004219 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00004220
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00004221 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00004222 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00004223 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004224 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00004225 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00004226 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004227 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCallca0408f2010-08-23 06:44:23 +00004228 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00004229 &literalType);
4230 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004231 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004232 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00004233
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00004234 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00004235 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00004236 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004237 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00004238 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00004239
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004240 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004241 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00004242}
4243
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004244ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004245Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004246 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
4247 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004248 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00004249
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00004250 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004251 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004252
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004253 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
4254 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00004255 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004256 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00004257}
4258
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004259/// Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages
4260/// except the final cast and returning the kind required.
4261static CastKind PrepareScalarCast(Sema &S, Expr *&Src, QualType DestTy) {
4262 // Both Src and Dest are scalar types, i.e. arithmetic or pointer.
4263 // Also, callers should have filtered out the invalid cases with
4264 // pointers. Everything else should be possible.
4265
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004266 QualType SrcTy = Src->getType();
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004267 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004268 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004269
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004270 switch (SrcTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4271 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4272 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
4273
4274 case Type::STK_Pointer:
4275 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4276 case Type::STK_Pointer:
4277 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004278 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
4279 CK_BitCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004280 case Type::STK_Bool:
4281 return CK_PointerToBoolean;
4282 case Type::STK_Integral:
4283 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
4284 case Type::STK_Floating:
4285 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
4286 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
4287 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4288 llvm_unreachable("illegal cast from pointer");
4289 }
4290 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004291
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004292 case Type::STK_Bool: // casting from bool is like casting from an integer
4293 case Type::STK_Integral:
4294 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4295 case Type::STK_Pointer:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004296 if (Src->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004297 return CK_NullToPointer;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004298 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004299 case Type::STK_Bool:
4300 return CK_IntegralToBoolean;
4301 case Type::STK_Integral:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004302 return CK_IntegralCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004303 case Type::STK_Floating:
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004304 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004305 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004306 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004307 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004308 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(DestTy)->getElementType(),
4309 CK_IntegralToFloating);
4310 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004311 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4312 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004313 }
4314 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004315
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004316 case Type::STK_Floating:
4317 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4318 case Type::STK_Floating:
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004319 return CK_FloatingCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004320 case Type::STK_Bool:
4321 return CK_FloatingToBoolean;
4322 case Type::STK_Integral:
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004323 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004324 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004325 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004326 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004327 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(DestTy)->getElementType(),
4328 CK_FloatingToIntegral);
4329 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004330 case Type::STK_Pointer:
4331 llvm_unreachable("valid float->pointer cast?");
4332 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4333 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004334 }
4335 break;
4336
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004337 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
4338 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4339 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004340 return CK_FloatingComplexCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004341 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004342 return CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004343 case Type::STK_Floating:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004344 return CK_FloatingComplexToReal;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004345 case Type::STK_Bool:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004346 return CK_FloatingComplexToBoolean;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004347 case Type::STK_Integral:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004348 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(SrcTy)->getElementType(),
4349 CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
4350 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004351 case Type::STK_Pointer:
4352 llvm_unreachable("valid complex float->pointer cast?");
4353 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4354 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004355 }
4356 break;
4357
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004358 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
4359 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4360 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004361 return CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004362 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004363 return CK_IntegralComplexCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004364 case Type::STK_Integral:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004365 return CK_IntegralComplexToReal;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004366 case Type::STK_Bool:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004367 return CK_IntegralComplexToBoolean;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004368 case Type::STK_Floating:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004369 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(SrcTy)->getElementType(),
4370 CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
4371 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004372 case Type::STK_Pointer:
4373 llvm_unreachable("valid complex int->pointer cast?");
4374 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4375 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004376 }
4377 break;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004378 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004379
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004380 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled scalar cast");
4381 return CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004382}
4383
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004384/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00004385bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004386 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004387 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00004388 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004389 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor40749ee2010-11-03 00:35:38 +00004390 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(SourceRange(TyR.getBegin(),
4391 castExpr->getLocEnd()),
4392 castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004393 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004394
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004395 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004396
4397 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
4398 // type needs to be scalar.
4399 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
4400 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004401 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004402 return false;
4403 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004404
Eli Friedman8d438082010-07-17 20:43:49 +00004405 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
4406 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
4407 return true;
4408
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004409 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004410 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004411 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
4412 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004413 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004414 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
4415 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004416 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004417 return false;
4418 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004419
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004420 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004421 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004422 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004423 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004424 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004425 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004426 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara8c4bfe52010-10-07 21:20:44 +00004427 castExpr->getType()) &&
4428 !Field->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004429 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
4430 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4431 break;
4432 }
4433 }
4434 if (Field == FieldEnd)
4435 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
4436 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004437 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004438 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004439 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004440
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004441 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4442 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4443 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4444 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004445
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004446 // The type we're casting to is known to be a scalar or vector.
4447
4448 // Require the operand to be a scalar or vector.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004449 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004450 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004451 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4452 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004453 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004454 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004455
4456 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004457 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004458
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004459 if (castType->isVectorType())
4460 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4461 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4462 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4463
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004464 // The source and target types are both scalars, i.e.
4465 // - arithmetic types (fundamental, enum, and complex)
4466 // - all kinds of pointers
4467 // Note that member pointers were filtered out with C++, above.
4468
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004469 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4470 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004471
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004472 // If either type is a pointer, the other type has to be either an
4473 // integer or a pointer.
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004474 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004475 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004476 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004477 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004478 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4479 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4480 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4481 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004482 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004483 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4484 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4485 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004486 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004487
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004488 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(*this, castExpr, castType);
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004489
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004490 if (Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004491 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4492
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004493 return false;
4494}
4495
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004496bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004497 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004498 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004499
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004500 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004501 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004502 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004503 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004504 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004505 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004506 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004507 } else
4508 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004509 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004510 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004511
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004512 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004513 return false;
4514}
4515
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004516bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004517 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004518 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004519
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004520 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004521
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004522 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4523 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004524 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4525 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4526 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4527 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004528 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004529 return false;
4530 }
4531
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004532 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004533 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4534 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004535 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4536 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4537 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4538 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004539
4540 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4541 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004542 PrepareScalarCast(*this, CastExpr, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004543
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004544 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004545 return false;
4546}
4547
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004548ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004549Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004550 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4551 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004552 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004553
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004554 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4555 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4556 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004557 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004558
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004559 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4560 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004561 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004562 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004563
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004564 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004565}
4566
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004567ExprResult
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004568Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004569 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004570 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004571 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004572 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004573 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004574 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004575
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004576 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004577 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004578 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4579 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004580}
4581
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004582/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4583/// of comma binary operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004584ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004585Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004586 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4587 if (!E)
4588 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004589
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004590 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004591
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004592 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004593 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4594 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004595
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004596 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4597
4598 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004599}
4600
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004601ExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004602Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004603 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004604 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004605 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004606 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004607 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004608
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004609 // Check for an altivec literal,
4610 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004611 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4612 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4613 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4614 return ExprError();
4615 }
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004616 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4617 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4618 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4619 }
4620 else
4621 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4622 }
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004623
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004624 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4625 // then handle it as such.
4626 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004627 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4628 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4629 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4630
4631 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4632 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004633 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4634 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004635 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4636 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004637 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004638 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004639 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004640 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004641 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004642 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4643 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004644 }
4645}
4646
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004647ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004648 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004649 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004650 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004651 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4652 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004653 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4654 Expr *expr;
4655 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4656 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4657 else
4658 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004659 return Owned(expr);
4660}
4661
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004662/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4663/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004664/// C99 6.5.15
4665QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004666 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004667 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Douglas Gregor7ad5d422010-11-09 21:07:58 +00004668 // If both LHS and RHS are overloaded functions, try to resolve them.
4669 if (Context.hasSameType(LHS->getType(), RHS->getType()) &&
4670 LHS->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Overload)) {
4671 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS, QuestionLoc);
4672 if (LHSResult.isInvalid())
4673 return QualType();
4674
4675 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS, QuestionLoc);
4676 if (RHSResult.isInvalid())
4677 return QualType();
4678
4679 LHS = LHSResult.take();
4680 RHS = RHSResult.take();
4681 }
4682
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004683 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4684 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004685 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004686
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004687 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004688 if (SAVE) {
4689 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4690 }
4691 else
4692 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004693 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4694 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4695 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4696 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004697
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004698 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004699 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004700 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4701 // Throw an error if its not either.
4702 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4703 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4704 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4705 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4706 << CondTy;
4707 return QualType();
4708 }
4709 }
4710 else {
4711 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4712 << CondTy;
4713 return QualType();
4714 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004715 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004716
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004717 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004718 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4719 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004720
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004721 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4722 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4723 // built in select.
4724 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4725 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4726 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4727 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4728 << CondTy;
4729 return QualType();
4730 }
4731 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4732 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4733 << CondTy;
4734 return QualType();
4735 }
4736 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4737 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4738 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4739 }
4740
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004741 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4742 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004743 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4744 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4745 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004746 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004747
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004748 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4749 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004750 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4751 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004752 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004753 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004754 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004755 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004756 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004757 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004758
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004759 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004760 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004761 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4762 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4763 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4764 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4765 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4766 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4767 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004768 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4769 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004770 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004771 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004772 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4773 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004774 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004775 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004776 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004777 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_NullToPointer);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004778 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004779 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004780 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004781 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004782 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_NullToPointer);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004783 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004784 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004785
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004786 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4787 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4788 QuestionLoc);
4789 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4790 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004791
4792
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004793 // Handle block pointer types.
4794 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4795 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4796 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4797 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004798 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4799 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004800 return destType;
4801 }
4802 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004803 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004804 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004805 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004806 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4807 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4808 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004809 return LHSTy;
4810 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004811 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004812 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4813 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004814
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004815 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4816 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004817 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004818 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004819 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4820 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4821 // to get a consistent AST.
4822 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004823 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4824 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004825 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004826 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004827 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004828 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4829 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004830 return LHSTy;
4831 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004832
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004833 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4834 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4835 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004836 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4837 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004838
4839 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4840 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4841 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004842 QualType destPointee
4843 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004844 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004845 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004846 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004847 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004848 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004849 return destType;
4850 }
4851 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004852 QualType destPointee
4853 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004854 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004855 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004856 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004857 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004858 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004859 return destType;
4860 }
4861
4862 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4863 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4864 return LHSTy;
4865 }
4866 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4867 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4868 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4869 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4870 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4871 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4872 // to get a consistent AST.
4873 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004874 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4875 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004876 return incompatTy;
4877 }
4878 // The pointer types are compatible.
4879 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4880 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4881 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4882 // type.
4883 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4884 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004885 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4886 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004887 return LHSTy;
4888 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004889
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004890 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch. Note that
4891 // null pointers have been filtered out by this point.
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004892 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4893 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4894 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004895 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004896 return RHSTy;
4897 }
4898 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4899 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4900 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004901 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004902 return LHSTy;
4903 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004904
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004905 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004906 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4907 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004908 return QualType();
4909}
4910
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004911/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4912/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4913QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4914 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4915 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4916 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004917
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004918 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4919 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4920 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4921 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4922 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004923 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004924 return LHSTy;
4925 }
4926 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4927 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004928 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004929 return RHSTy;
4930 }
4931 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4932 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4933 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004934 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004935 return LHSTy;
4936 }
4937 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4938 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004939 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004940 return RHSTy;
4941 }
4942 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4943 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4944 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004945 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004946 return LHSTy;
4947 }
4948 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4949 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004950 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004951 return RHSTy;
4952 }
4953 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4954 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004955
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004956 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4957 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4958 return LHSTy;
4959 }
4960 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4961 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4962 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004963
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004964 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4965 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4966 // type. This allows
4967 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4968 // where B is a subclass of A.
4969 //
4970 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4971 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4972 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4973 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004974
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004975 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4976 // It could return the composite type.
4977 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4978 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4979 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4980 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4981 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4982 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4983 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4984 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4985 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4986 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4987 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4988 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4989 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4990 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004991 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004992 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4993 ;
4994 else {
4995 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4996 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4997 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4998 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004999 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
5000 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005001 return incompatTy;
5002 }
5003 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005004 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
5005 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005006 return compositeType;
5007 }
5008 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
5009 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
5010 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5011 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5012 QualType destPointee
5013 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
5014 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
5015 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005016 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005017 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005018 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005019 return destType;
5020 }
5021 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
5022 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5023 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5024 QualType destPointee
5025 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
5026 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
5027 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005028 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005029 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005030 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005031 return destType;
5032 }
5033 return QualType();
5034}
5035
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00005036/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005037/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00005038ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00005039 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005040 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
5041 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00005042 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
5043 // was the condition.
5044 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00005045 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
5046 if (isLHSNull) {
5047 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
5048 }
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00005049
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00005050 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
5051 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005052 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00005053 return ExprError();
5054
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00005055 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00005056 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
5057 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
5058 result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005059}
5060
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005061// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005062// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005063// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
5064// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
5065// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005066Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005067Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
5068 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005069
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00005070 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
5071 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
5072 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
5073 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
5074 return Compatible;
5075 }
5076
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005077 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005078 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5079 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005080
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005081 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005082 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
5083 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005084
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005085 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005086
5087 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
5088 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
5089 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00005090 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005091 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005092 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005093
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005094 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
5095 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005096 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005097 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005098 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005099 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005100
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005101 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005102 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
5103 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005104 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005105
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005106 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005107 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005108 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005109
5110 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005111 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
5112 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005113 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005114 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005115 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005116 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
5117 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
5118 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
5119 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
5120 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
5121 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00005122 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005123 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005124 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005125 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005126
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00005127 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005128 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005129 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005130 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00005131
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005132 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
5133 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
5134 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
5135 // warning can be disabled.
5136 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
5137 return ConvTy;
5138 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
5139 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005140
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00005141 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
5142 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
5143 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
5144 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
5145 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
5146 do {
5147 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5148 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005149
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00005150 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
5151 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
5152 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005153
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00005154 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00005155 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00005156 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005157
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005158 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005159 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005160 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005161 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005162}
5163
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005164/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
5165/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
5166/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
5167// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005168Sema::AssignConvertType
5169Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005170 QualType rhsType) {
5171 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005172
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005173 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005174 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5175 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005176
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005177 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
5178 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
5179 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005180
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005181 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005182
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005183 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00005184 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005185 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005186
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00005187 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5188 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
5189 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
5190 }
5191 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005192 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005193 return ConvTy;
5194}
5195
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005196/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
5197/// for assignment compatibility.
5198Sema::AssignConvertType
5199Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005200 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
5201 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00005202 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
5203 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005204 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005205 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005206 }
5207 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
5208 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00005209 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
5210 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005211 return IncompatiblePointer;
5212 return Compatible;
5213 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005214 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005215 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005216 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005217 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5218 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
5219 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
5220 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
5221 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
5222 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005223
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005224 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
5225 return Compatible;
5226 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
5227 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005228 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005229}
5230
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005231Sema::AssignConvertType
5232Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
5233 // Fake up an opaque expression. We don't actually care about what
5234 // cast operations are required, so if CheckAssignmentConstraints
5235 // adds casts to this they'll be wasted, but fortunately that doesn't
5236 // usually happen on valid code.
5237 OpaqueValueExpr rhs(rhsType, VK_RValue);
5238 Expr *rhsPtr = &rhs;
5239 CastKind K = CK_Invalid;
5240
5241 return CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rhsPtr, K);
5242}
5243
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005244/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
5245/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005246/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
5247///
5248/// int a, *pint;
5249/// short *pshort;
5250/// struct foo *pfoo;
5251///
5252/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
5253/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
5254/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
5255/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
5256///
5257/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005258/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005259///
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005260/// Sets 'Kind' for any result kind except Incompatible.
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005261Sema::AssignConvertType
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005262Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rhs,
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005263 CastKind &Kind) {
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005264 QualType rhsType = rhs->getType();
5265
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005266 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
5267 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005268 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
5269 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005270
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005271 if (lhsType == rhsType) {
5272 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00005273 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005274 }
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00005275
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00005276 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
5277 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
5278 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
5279 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005280 Kind = CK_BitCast;
5281 return Compatible;
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00005282 }
5283
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005284 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
5285 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
5286 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
5287 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
5288 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
5289 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
5290 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005291 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005292 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType)) {
5293 Kind = CK_LValueBitCast;
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00005294 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005295 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005296 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00005297 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005298 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
5299 // to the same ExtVector type.
5300 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5301 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005302 return Incompatible;
5303 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType()) {
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005304 // CK_VectorSplat does T -> vector T, so first cast to the
5305 // element type.
5306 QualType elType = cast<ExtVectorType>(lhsType)->getElementType();
5307 if (elType != rhsType) {
5308 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(*this, rhs, elType);
5309 ImpCastExprToType(rhs, elType, Kind);
5310 }
5311 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005312 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005313 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005314 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005315
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005316 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005317 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
5318 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5319 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
5320 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5321 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005322 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))) {
John McCall0c6d28d2010-11-15 10:08:00 +00005323 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005324 return IncompatibleVectors;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005325 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005326
5327 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
5328 // vector type and vice versa
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005329 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCall0c6d28d2010-11-15 10:08:00 +00005330 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005331 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005332 }
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00005333 }
5334 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005335 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005336
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00005337 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005338 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005339 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(*this, rhs, lhsType);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005340 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005341 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005342
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005343 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005344 if (rhsType->isIntegerType()) {
5345 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null?
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00005346 return IntToPointer;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005347 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005348
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005349 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
5350 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005351 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005352 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005353
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005354 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005355 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005356 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast;
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005357 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5358 return Compatible;
5359 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005360 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005361 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005362 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
5363 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005364 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005365 }
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005366
5367 // Treat block pointers as objects.
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005368 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType()) {
5369 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005370 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005371 }
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005372 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005373 return Incompatible;
5374 }
5375
5376 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005377 if (rhsType->isIntegerType()) {
5378 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00005379 return IntToBlockPointer;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005380 }
5381
5382 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005383
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005384 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005385 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005386 return Compatible;
5387
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005388 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
5389 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005390
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005391 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005392 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005393 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005394
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005395 return Incompatible;
5396 }
5397
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005398 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005399 if (rhsType->isIntegerType()) {
5400 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005401 return IntToPointer;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005402 }
5403
5404 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005405
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005406 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005407 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005408 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5409 return Compatible;
5410 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005411 }
5412 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005413 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005414 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005415 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005416 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
5417 return Compatible;
5418 }
5419 // Treat block pointers as objects.
5420 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
5421 return Compatible;
5422 return Incompatible;
5423 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005424 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005425 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005426 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy) {
5427 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005428 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005429 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005430
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005431 if (lhsType->isIntegerType()) {
5432 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00005433 return PointerToInt;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005434 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005435
5436 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005437 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
5438 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005439 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005440 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005441 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005442 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005443 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
5444 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005445 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy) {
5446 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005447 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005448 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005449
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005450 if (lhsType->isIntegerType()) {
5451 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005452 return PointerToInt;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005453 }
5454
5455 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005456
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005457 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005458 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005459 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5460 return Compatible;
5461 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005462 }
5463 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005464 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
5465 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005466 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005467 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005468 return Incompatible;
5469 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005470
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005471 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005472 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType)) {
5473 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005474 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005475 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005476 }
5477 return Incompatible;
5478}
5479
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005480/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
5481/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005482static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005483 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
5484 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
5485 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00005486 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00005487 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005488 SourceLocation());
5489 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
5490 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
5491
5492 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
5493 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005494 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00005495 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005496 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005497}
5498
5499Sema::AssignConvertType
5500Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
5501 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
5502
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005503 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005504 // transparent_union GCC extension.
5505 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005506 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005507 return Incompatible;
5508
5509 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
5510 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
5511 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
5512 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00005513 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
5514 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005515 it != itend; ++it) {
5516 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
5517 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
5518 // 1) void pointer
5519 // 2) null pointer constant
5520 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005521 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005522 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005523 InitField = *it;
5524 break;
5525 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005526
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005527 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005528 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00005529 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005530 InitField = *it;
5531 break;
5532 }
5533 }
5534
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005535 Expr *rhs = rExpr;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005536 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005537 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rhs, Kind)
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005538 == Compatible) {
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005539 ImpCastExprToType(rhs, it->getType(), Kind);
5540 rExpr = rhs;
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005541 InitField = *it;
5542 break;
5543 }
5544 }
5545
5546 if (!InitField)
5547 return Incompatible;
5548
5549 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5550 return Compatible;
5551}
5552
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005553Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005554Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005555 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5556 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5557 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5558 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5559 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005560 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005561 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005562 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005563 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005564 }
5565
5566 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5567 // structures.
5568 }
5569
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005570 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5571 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005572 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5573 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005574 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005575 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005576 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005577 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_NullToPointer);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005578 return Compatible;
5579 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005580
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005581 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005582 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005583 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyc133e9e2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005584 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005585 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005586 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005587 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005588 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005589
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005590 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005591 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005592 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr, Kind);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005593
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005594 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5595 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005596 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5597 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5598 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5599 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005600 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005601 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context), Kind);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005602 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005603}
5604
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005605QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005606 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005607 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005608 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005609 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005610}
5611
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005612QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005613 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005614 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005615 QualType lhsType =
5616 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5617 QualType rhsType =
5618 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005619
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005620 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005621 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005622 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005623
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005624 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5625 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005626 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005627 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005628 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005629 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005630 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005631 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005632 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005633 return lhsType;
5634 }
5635
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005636 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005637 return rhsType;
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005638 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5639 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5640 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5641 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5642 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5643 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005644 }
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005645 }
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005646 }
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005647 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005648
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005649 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5650 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5651 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005652 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005653 return rhsType;
5654 }
5655
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005656 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5657 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5658 bool swapped = false;
5659 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5660 swapped = true;
5661 std::swap(rex, lex);
5662 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5663 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005664
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005665 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005666 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005667 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005668 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005669 int order = Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType);
5670 if (order > 0)
5671 ImpCastExprToType(rex, EltTy, CK_IntegralCast);
5672 if (order >= 0) {
5673 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_VectorSplat);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005674 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5675 return lhsType;
5676 }
5677 }
5678 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5679 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005680 int order = Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType);
5681 if (order > 0)
5682 ImpCastExprToType(rex, EltTy, CK_FloatingCast);
5683 if (order >= 0) {
5684 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_VectorSplat);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005685 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5686 return lhsType;
5687 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005688 }
5689 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005690
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005691 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005692 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005693 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005694 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005695 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005696}
5697
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005698QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5699 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005700 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005701 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005702
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005703 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005704
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005705 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5706 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5707 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005708
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005709 // Check for division by zero.
5710 if (isDiv &&
5711 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005712 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005713 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005714
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005715 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005716}
5717
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005718QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005719 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005720 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005721 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5722 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005723 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5724 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5725 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005726
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005727 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005728
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005729 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5730 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005731
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005732 // Check for remainder by zero.
5733 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005734 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5735 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005736
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005737 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005738}
5739
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005740QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005741 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005742 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5743 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5744 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5745 return compType;
5746 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005747
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005748 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005749
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005750 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005751 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5752 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5753 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005754 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005755 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005756
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005757 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5758 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005759 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005760 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5761
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005762 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005763
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005764 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005765 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005766
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005767 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5768 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005769 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5770 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005771 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005772 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005773 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005774
5775 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5776 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5777 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005778 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005779 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5780 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5781 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5782 return QualType();
5783 }
5784
5785 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5786 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5787 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005788 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005789 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005790 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005791 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005792 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5793 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005794 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5795 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005796 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005797 return QualType();
5798 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005799 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005800 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005801 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5802 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5803 return QualType();
5804 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005805
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005806 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005807 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5808 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5809 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5810 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5811 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005812 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005813 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5814 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005815 return PExp->getType();
5816 }
5817 }
5818
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005819 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005820}
5821
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005822// C99 6.5.6
5823QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005824 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5825 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5826 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5827 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5828 return compType;
5829 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005830
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005831 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005832
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005833 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005834
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005835 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005836 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5837 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005838 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005839 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005840 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005841
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005842 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005843 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005844 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005845
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005846 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005847
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005848 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5849 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5850 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5851 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5852 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5853 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5854 return QualType();
5855 }
5856
5857 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5858 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5859 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5860 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5861 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005862 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005863 return QualType();
5864 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005865
5866 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5867 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5868 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005869 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005870 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005871 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005872 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005873 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005874
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005875 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005876 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005877 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5878 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5879 return QualType();
5880 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005881
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005882 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005883 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5884 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5885 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5886 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5887 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5888 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005889 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005890 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5891
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005892 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005893 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005894 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005895
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005896 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005897 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005898 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005899
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005900 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5901 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5902 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5903 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5904 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5905 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5906 return QualType();
5907 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005908
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005909 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5910 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5911 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5912 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005913 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005914 return QualType();
5915 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005916
5917 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5918 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5919 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5920 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5921 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005922 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5923 << rex->getSourceRange()
5924 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005925 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005926
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005927 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5928 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5929 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5930 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5931 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5932 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5933 return QualType();
5934 }
5935 } else {
5936 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5937 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5938 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5939 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5940 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5941 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5942 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5943 return QualType();
5944 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005945 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005946
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005947 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5948 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5949 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5950 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5951 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005952 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005953 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005954
5955 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005956 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5957 }
5958 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005959
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005960 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005961}
5962
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005963static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
5964 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
5965 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
5966 return false;
5967}
5968
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005969// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005970QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005971 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005972 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005973 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5974 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005975 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005976
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005977 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
5978 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
5979 if (isScopedEnumerationType(lex->getType()) ||
5980 isScopedEnumerationType(rex->getType())) {
5981 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5982 }
5983
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005984 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5985 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5986 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5987
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005988 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5989 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005990 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5991 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5992 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5993 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5994 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005995 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005996 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005997 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005998
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005999 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006000
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00006001 // Sanity-check shift operands
6002 llvm::APSInt Right;
6003 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00006004 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
6005 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00006006 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00006007 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
6008 else {
6009 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
6010 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
6011 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
6012 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
6013 }
6014 }
6015
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00006016 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006017 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006018}
6019
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006020static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
6021 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
6022 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
6023 return true;
6024 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
6025 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
6026 }
6027 return false;
6028}
6029
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006030// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006031QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006032 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006033 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006034
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00006035 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006036 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006037 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006038
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006039 QualType lType = lex->getType();
6040 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006041
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006042 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00006043 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
6044 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
6045 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006046 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
6047 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
6048 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00006049 //
6050 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
6051 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
6052 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
6053 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
6054 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
6055 // result.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006056 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
6057 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006058 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006059 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00006060 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006061 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006062 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
6063 << 0 // self-
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006064 << (Opc == BO_EQ
6065 || Opc == BO_LE
6066 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006067 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
6068 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
6069 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
6070 // what is it always going to eval to?
6071 char always_evals_to;
6072 switch(Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006073 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006074 always_evals_to = 0; // false
6075 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006076 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006077 always_evals_to = 1; // true
6078 break;
6079 default:
6080 // best we can say is 'a constant'
6081 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
6082 break;
6083 }
6084 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
6085 << 1 // array
6086 << always_evals_to);
6087 }
6088 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006089 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006090
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006091 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
6092 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
6093 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
6094 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006095
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006096 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
6097 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006098 Expr *literalString = 0;
6099 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006100 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006101 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006102 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006103 literalString = lex;
6104 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00006105 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
6106 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006107 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006108 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006109 literalString = rex;
6110 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
6111 }
6112
6113 if (literalString) {
6114 std::string resultComparison;
6115 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006116 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
6117 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
6118 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
6119 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
6120 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
6121 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006122 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
6123 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006124
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00006125 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
6126 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
6127 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00006128 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006129 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00006130 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006131
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006132 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
6133 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
6134 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
6135 else {
6136 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
6137 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
6138 }
6139
6140 lType = lex->getType();
6141 rType = rex->getType();
6142
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006143 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00006144 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006145
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006146 if (isRelational) {
6147 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006148 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006149 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00006150 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006151 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006152 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006153
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006154 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006155 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006156 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006157
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006158 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006159 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006160 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006161 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006162
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006163 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
6164 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00006165 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00006166 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006167 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00006168 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006169 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006170
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006171 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006172 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
6173 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006174 if (!isRelational &&
6175 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
6176 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
6177 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006178 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
6179 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006180 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6181 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006182 Diag(Loc,
6183 isSFINAEContext()?
6184 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
6185 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006186 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006187
6188 if (isSFINAEContext())
6189 return QualType();
6190
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006191 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006192 return ResultTy;
6193 }
6194 }
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006195
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006196 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
6197 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
6198 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
6199 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
6200 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
6201 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006202 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006203 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006204 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00006205 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006206 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006207 if (T.isNull()) {
6208 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
6209 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6210 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006211 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006212 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006213 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006214 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006215 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006216 }
6217
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006218 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
6219 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006220 return ResultTy;
6221 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006222 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
6223 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
6224 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
6225 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
6226 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
6227 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
6228 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6229 }
6230 } else if (!isRelational &&
6231 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
6232 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
6233 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6234 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
6235 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
6236 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6237 }
6238 } else {
6239 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00006240 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006241 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006242 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006243 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006244 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006245 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00006246 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006247
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006248 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006249 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
6250 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
6251 return ResultTy;
6252
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006253 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006254 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006255 if (RHSIsNull &&
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006256 ((lType->isPointerType() || lType->isNullPtrType()) ||
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006257 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00006258 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
6259 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006260 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006261 : CK_NullToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006262 return ResultTy;
6263 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006264 if (LHSIsNull &&
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006265 ((rType->isPointerType() || rType->isNullPtrType()) ||
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006266 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00006267 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
6268 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006269 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006270 : CK_NullToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006271 return ResultTy;
6272 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006273
6274 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006275 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006276 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
6277 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006278 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
6279 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
6280 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
6281 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
6282 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
6283 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
6284 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
6285 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006286 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006287 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00006288 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006289 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006290 if (T.isNull()) {
6291 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006292 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006293 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006294 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006295 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006296 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006297 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006298 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006299 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006300
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006301 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
6302 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006303 return ResultTy;
6304 }
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006305 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006306
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006307 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006308 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006309 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6310 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006311
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006312 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00006313 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00006314 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006315 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006316 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006317 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006318 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006319 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006320 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006321 if (!isRelational
6322 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
6323 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006324 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006325 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006326 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006327 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006328 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
6329 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
6330 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006331 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006332 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006333 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006334 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006335
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006336 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00006337 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006338 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
6339 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006340 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00006341 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006342 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00006343 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006344
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00006345 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
6346 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00006347 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006348 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00006349 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006350 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006351 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00006352 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006353 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00006354 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006355 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
6356 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006357 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006358 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00006359 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00006360 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006361 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
6362 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006363 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006364 bool isError = false;
6365 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
6366 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
6367 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006368 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006369 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006370 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006371 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6372 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
6373 isError = true;
6374 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006375 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006376
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006377 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00006378 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00006379 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006380 if (isError)
6381 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00006382 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006383
6384 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006385 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
6386 LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006387 else
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006388 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
6389 RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006390 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006391 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006392
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00006393 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006394 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
6395 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006396 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006397 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00006398 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006399 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
6400 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006401 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006402 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00006403 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006404 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006405}
6406
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006407/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006408/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006409/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
6410/// types.
6411QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006412 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006413 bool isRelational) {
6414 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
6415 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006416 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006417 if (vType.isNull())
6418 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006419
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006420 QualType lType = lex->getType();
6421 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006422
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006423 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
6424 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
6425 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006426 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006427 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
6428 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
6429 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006430 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
6431 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
6432 << 0 // self-
6433 << 2 // "a constant"
6434 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006435 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006436
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006437 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006438 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
6439 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006440 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006441 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006442
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006443 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
6444 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
6445 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006446 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006447 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006448
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006449 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006450 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006451 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006452 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00006453 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006454 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
6455
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006456 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006457 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006458 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
6459}
6460
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006461inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006462 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006463 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
6464 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
6465 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6466 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6467
6468 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6469 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00006470
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006471 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006472
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00006473 if (lex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
6474 rex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006475 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006476 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006477}
6478
6479inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006480 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
6481
6482 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
6483 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
6484 // is a constant.
6485 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman787b0942010-07-27 19:14:53 +00006486 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattner23ef3e42010-07-15 00:26:43 +00006487 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006488 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
6489 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
6490 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
6491 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
6492 Expr::EvalResult Result;
6493 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
6494 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
6495 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
6496 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006497 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
6498 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006499 }
6500 }
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006501
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006502 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6503 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
6504 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006505
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006506 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
6507 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006508
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006509 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00006510 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006511
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006512 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
6513 // non-overloadable operands.
6514
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006515 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
6516 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006517 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
6518 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
6519 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006520 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006521
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006522 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
6523 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
6524 // The result is a bool.
6525 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006526}
6527
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006528/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
6529/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
6530/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
6531///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006532static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006533 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
6534 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
6535 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00006536 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->isSuperReceiver() ?
6537 PropExpr->getSuperType() :
6538 PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
6539
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006540 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006541 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
6542 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
6543 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
6544 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006545 }
6546 }
6547 return false;
6548}
6549
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006550/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6551/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6552static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006553 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006554 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006555 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006556 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6557 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006558 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6559 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006560
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006561 unsigned Diag = 0;
6562 bool NeedType = false;
6563 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006564 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006565 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006566 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6567 NeedType = true;
6568 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006569 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006570 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6571 NeedType = true;
6572 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006573 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006574 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6575 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006576 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6577 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006578 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006579 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6580 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006581 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6582 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006583 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6584 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006585 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006586 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006587 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006588 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006589 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6590 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006591 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006592 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6593 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006594 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6595 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6596 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006597 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6598 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6599 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006600 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6601 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6602 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006603 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006604
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006605 SourceRange Assign;
6606 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6607 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006608 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006609 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006610 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006611 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006612 return true;
6613}
6614
6615
6616
6617// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006618QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6619 SourceLocation Loc,
6620 QualType CompoundType) {
6621 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6622 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006623 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006624
6625 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6626 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006627 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006628 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006629 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006630 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006631 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006632 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006633 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6634 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6635 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006636 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006637 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006638 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006639 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006640
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006641 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6642 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6643 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006644 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006645 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6646 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6647 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006648 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6649 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006650 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006651 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006652 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6653 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6654 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006655 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6656 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006657 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006658 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006659 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006660 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006661 }
6662 } else {
6663 // Compound assignment "x += y"
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00006664 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006665 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006666
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006667 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006668 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006669 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006670
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006671
6672 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6673 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6674 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6675 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6676 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6677 // check.
6678 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006679 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006680 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6681 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6682 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6683 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6684 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6685 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6686 }
6687
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006688 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6689 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006690 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006691 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6692 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006693 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006694 // operand.
John McCall2bf6f492010-10-12 02:19:57 +00006695 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6696 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006697}
6698
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006699// C99 6.5.17
6700QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006701 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6702
Douglas Gregor7ad5d422010-11-09 21:07:58 +00006703 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS, Loc);
6704 if (LHSResult.isInvalid())
6705 return QualType();
6706
6707 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS, Loc);
6708 if (RHSResult.isInvalid())
6709 return QualType();
6710 RHS = RHSResult.take();
6711
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006712 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
6713 // operands, but not unary promotions.
6714 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6715 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6716 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS);
6717 if (!LHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6718 RequireCompleteType(Loc, LHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006719
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006720 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
6721 if (!RHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6722 RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
6723 }
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006724
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006725 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006726}
6727
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006728/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6729/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006730QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006731 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006732 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6733 return Context.DependentTy;
6734
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006735 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6736 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006737
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006738 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6739 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6740 if (!isInc) {
6741 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6742 return QualType();
6743 }
6744 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6745 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6746 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006747 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006748 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6749 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006750
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006751 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006752 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006753 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6754 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6755 << Op->getSourceRange();
6756 return QualType();
6757 }
6758
6759 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006760 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006761 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006762 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6763 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6764 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6765 return QualType();
6766 }
6767
6768 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006769 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006770 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006771 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006772 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006773 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006774 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006775 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006776 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006777 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6778 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6779 return QualType();
6780 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006781 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006782 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6783 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006784 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006785 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6786 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6787 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6788 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc, isInc, isPrefix);
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006789 } else {
6790 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006791 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006792 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006793 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006794 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006795 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006796 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006797 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006798 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6799 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6800 // operand.
6801 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6802 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006803}
6804
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006805void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6806 bool copyInit = false;
6807 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6808 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6809 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6810 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6811 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6812 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6813 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6814 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6815 }
6816 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6817 }
6818 else
6819 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6820 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6821 if (copyInit) {
6822 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006823 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006824 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6825 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6826 Owned(Arg));
6827 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006828 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006829 }
6830}
6831
6832
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006833/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006834/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006835/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6836/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6837/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6838/// - &(x) => x
6839/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6840/// - &s.xx => s
6841/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6842/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6843/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6844/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006845static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006846 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006847 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006848 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006849 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006850 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6851 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6852 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006853 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006854 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006855 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006856 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006857 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006858 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6859 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006860 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6861 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6862 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6863 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6864 }
6865 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006866 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006867 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6868 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006869
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006870 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006871 case UO_Real:
6872 case UO_Imag:
6873 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006874 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6875 default:
6876 return 0;
6877 }
6878 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006879 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006880 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006881 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006882 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6883 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006884 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006885 default:
6886 return 0;
6887 }
6888}
6889
6890/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006891/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006892/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006893/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006894/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006895/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006896/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006897QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6898 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006899 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006900 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6901 return Context.OverloadTy;
6902
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006903 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp, OpLoc);
6904 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6905 OrigOp = PR.take();
6906
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006907 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6908 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006909
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006910 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6911 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6912 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006913 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006914 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6915 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6916 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6917 }
6918 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6919 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6920 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006921 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006922 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006923
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006924 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006925 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6926 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6927 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6928 if (isSFINAEContext())
6929 return QualType();
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006930 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006931 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006932 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6933 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6934 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6935
6936 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6937 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6938 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6939 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6940 return QualType();
6941 }
6942 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6943 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6944
6945 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6946 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6947 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6948 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6949
6950 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6951 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6952 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6953 << op->getSourceRange();
6954 }
6955
6956 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6957 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6958 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006959 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006960 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006961 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006962 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006963 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6964 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006965 return QualType();
6966 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006967 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006968 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6969 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6970 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006971 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006972 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006973 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006974 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006975 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006976 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006977 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6978 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6979 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6980 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6981 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006982 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6983 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006984 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6985 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006986 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006987 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006988 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6989 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006990 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6991 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCalld931b082010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006992 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006993 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006994 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6995 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006996 return QualType();
6997 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006998 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006999 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00007000 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00007001 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00007002 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
7003 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00007004 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00007005 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00007006 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
7007 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007008 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00007009 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
7010 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
7011 return QualType();
7012 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007013
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00007014 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
7015 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00007016 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00007017 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00007018 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007019 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007020 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00007021
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00007022 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
7023 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
7024 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
7025 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
7026 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
7027 }
7028
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007029 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor8f70ddb2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00007030 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
7031 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007032 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
7033}
7034
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007035/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00007036QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007037 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
7038 return Context.DependentTy;
7039
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00007040 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007041 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
7042 QualType Result;
7043
7044 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
7045 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
7046 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
7047 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
7048 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7049 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
7050 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
7051 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
7052 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007053 else {
7054 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
7055 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
7056 if (PR.take() != Op) return CheckIndirectionOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc);
7057 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007058
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007059 if (Result.isNull()) {
7060 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
7061 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
7062 return QualType();
7063 }
7064
7065 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007066}
7067
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007068static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007069 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007070 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007071 switch (Kind) {
7072 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007073 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
7074 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
7075 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
7076 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
7077 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
7078 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
7079 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
7080 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
7081 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
7082 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
7083 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
7084 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
7085 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
7086 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
7087 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
7088 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
7089 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
7090 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
7091 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
7092 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
7093 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
7094 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
7095 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
7096 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
7097 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
7098 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
7099 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
7100 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
7101 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
7102 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
7103 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
7104 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007105 }
7106 return Opc;
7107}
7108
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007109static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007110 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007111 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007112 switch (Kind) {
7113 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007114 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
7115 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
7116 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
7117 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
7118 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
7119 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
7120 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
7121 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
7122 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
7123 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
7124 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007125 }
7126 return Opc;
7127}
7128
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007129/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
7130/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
7131/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007132ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007133 unsigned Op,
7134 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007135 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007136 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007137 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
7138 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
7139 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007140
7141 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007142 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007143 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
7144 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007145 case BO_PtrMemD:
7146 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00007147 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007148 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00007149 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007150 case BO_Mul:
7151 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00007152 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007153 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007154 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007155 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007156 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7157 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007158 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007159 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7160 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007161 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007162 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7163 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007164 case BO_Shl:
7165 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007166 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7167 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007168 case BO_LE:
7169 case BO_LT:
7170 case BO_GE:
7171 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00007172 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007173 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007174 case BO_EQ:
7175 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00007176 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007177 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007178 case BO_And:
7179 case BO_Xor:
7180 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007181 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7182 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007183 case BO_LAnd:
7184 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00007185 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007186 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007187 case BO_MulAssign:
7188 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00007189 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007190 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007191 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
7192 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7193 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007194 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007195 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007196 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
7197 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
7198 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7199 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007200 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007201 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007202 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
7203 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7204 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007205 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007206 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007207 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
7208 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7209 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007210 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007211 case BO_ShlAssign:
7212 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007213 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
7214 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
7215 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7216 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007217 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007218 case BO_AndAssign:
7219 case BO_XorAssign:
7220 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007221 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
7222 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
7223 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7224 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007225 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007226 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007227 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7228 break;
7229 }
7230 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00007231 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00007232 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007233 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00007234 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
7235 << ResultTy;
7236 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007237 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007238 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
7239 else
7240 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007241 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
7242 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007243}
7244
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007245/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
7246/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007247static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
7248 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007249 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
7250 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
7251 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007252 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007253 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
7254
7255 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
7256 return;
7257
7258 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
7259 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
7260 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007261 return;
7262 }
7263
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007264 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
7265 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007266 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007267
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007268 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007269 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007270
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007271 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
7272 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
7273 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
7274 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007275 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007276 return;
7277 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007278
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007279 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007280 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
7281 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007282}
7283
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007284/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
7285/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
7286/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
7287/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007288static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007289 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007290 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
7291 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
7292 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
7293 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007294 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007295 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007296 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
7297
7298 // Subs are not binary operators.
7299 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
7300 return;
7301
7302 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
7303 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007304 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
7305 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007306 return;
7307
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007308 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007309 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007310 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007311 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
7312 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007313 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007314 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007315 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
7316 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
7317 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
7318 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007319 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007320 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007321 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007322 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
7323 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007324 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007325 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007326 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
7327 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
7328 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
7329 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007330}
7331
7332/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
7333/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
7334/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007335static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007336 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007337 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007338 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
7339}
7340
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007341// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007342ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007343 tok::TokenKind Kind,
7344 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
7345 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00007346 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
7347 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007348
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007349 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
7350 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
7351
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007352 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
7353}
7354
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007355ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007356 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
7357 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007358 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00007359 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
7360 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianeb17e8b2010-09-17 20:45:45 +00007361 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007362 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007363 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
7364 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
7365 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
7366 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
7367 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007368 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007369 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007370 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
7371 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
7372 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007373
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007374 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
7375 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007376 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00007377 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007378
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007379 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007380 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007381}
7382
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007383ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007384 unsigned OpcIn,
7385 Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007386 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007387
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007388 QualType resultType;
7389 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007390 case UO_PreInc:
7391 case UO_PreDec:
7392 case UO_PostInc:
7393 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00007394 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007395 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
7396 Opc == UO_PostInc,
7397 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
7398 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007399 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007400 case UO_AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007401 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
7402 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007403 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007404 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007405 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
7406 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007407 case UO_Plus:
7408 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00007409 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
7410 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007411 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7412 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00007413 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
7414 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007415 break;
7416 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
7417 resultType->isEnumeralType())
7418 break;
7419 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007420 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007421 resultType->isPointerType())
7422 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007423 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7424 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7425 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7426 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7427 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007428
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007429 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7430 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007431 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00007432 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
7433 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007434 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7435 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00007436 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
7437 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
7438 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00007439 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00007440 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007441 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
7442 break;
7443 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7444 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7445 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7446 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7447 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007448 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7449 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007450 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007451 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007452 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007453 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007454 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00007455 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007456 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7457 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007458 if (resultType->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.3.3p1
7459 // ok, fallthrough
7460 } else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7461 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7462 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7463 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7464 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007465 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7466 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007467 }
Douglas Gregorea844f32010-09-20 17:13:33 +00007468
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007469 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007470 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
7471 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007472 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007473 case UO_Real:
7474 case UO_Imag:
7475 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00007476 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007477 case UO_Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007478 resultType = Input->getType();
7479 break;
7480 }
7481 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007482 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007483
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007484 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007485}
7486
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007487ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007488 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
7489 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00007490 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman957c0942010-09-05 23:15:52 +00007491 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007492 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
7493 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
7494 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
7495 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007496 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007497 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007498 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
7499 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
7500 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007501
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007502 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007503 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007504
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007505 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007506}
7507
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007508// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007509ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007510 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
7511 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007512}
7513
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00007514/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007515ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007516 SourceLocation LabLoc,
7517 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007518 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007519 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007520
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00007521 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
7522 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00007523 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007524 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007525
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007526 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007527 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007528 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
7529 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007530}
7531
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007532ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007533Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007534 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007535 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
7536 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
7537
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00007538 bool isFileScope
7539 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00007540 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007541 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00007542
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007543 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
7544 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
7545 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007546
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007547 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
7548 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
7549 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007550 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007551 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
7552 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007553 LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = 0;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007554 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007555 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) {
7556 LastLabelStmt = Label;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007557 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007558 }
7559 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4bdc4462010-10-27 20:44:00 +00007560 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LastExpr);
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007561 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007562 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
7563 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
7564 InitializedEntity::InitializeResult(LPLoc,
7565 Ty,
7566 false),
7567 SourceLocation(),
7568 Owned(LastExpr));
7569 if (Res.isInvalid())
7570 return ExprError();
7571 if ((LastExpr = Res.takeAs<Expr>())) {
7572 if (!LastLabelStmt)
7573 Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr);
7574 else
7575 LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr);
7576 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true;
7577 }
7578 }
7579 }
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007580 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007581
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007582 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
7583 // expressions are not lvalues.
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007584 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc);
7585 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp)
7586 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr);
7587 return Owned(ResStmtExpr);
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007588}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007589
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007590ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007591 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7592 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7593 unsigned NumComponents,
7594 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007595 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007596 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00007597 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007598
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007599 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
7600 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
7601 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007602 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007603 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7604 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
7605
7606 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
7607 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
7608 if (!Dependent
7609 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
7610 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
7611 << TypeRange))
7612 return ExprError();
7613
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007614 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7615 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007616 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7617 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007618 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007619 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7620 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007621
7622 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
7623 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
7624 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
7625 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
7626 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
7627 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7628 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7629 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7630 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7631 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7632 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7633 if(!AT)
7634 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7635 << CurrentType);
7636 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7637 } else
7638 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7639
7640 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7641 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7642 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7643 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7644 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7645 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7646 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7647 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7648
7649 // Record this array index.
7650 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7651 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7652 continue;
7653 }
7654
7655 // Offset of a field.
7656 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7657 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7658 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7659 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7660 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7661 continue;
7662 }
7663
7664 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7665 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7666 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7667 return ExprError();
7668
7669 // Look for the designated field.
7670 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7671 if (!RC)
7672 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7673 << CurrentType);
7674 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7675
7676 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7677 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7678 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7679 // (clause 9).
7680 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7681 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7682 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7683 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7684 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7685 << CurrentType))
7686 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7687 }
7688
7689 // Look for the field.
7690 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7691 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7692 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7693 if (!MemberDecl)
7694 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7695 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7696 OC.LocEnd));
7697
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007698 // C99 7.17p3:
7699 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7700 //
7701 // We diagnose this as an error.
7702 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7703 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7704 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7705 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7706 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7707 return ExprError();
7708 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007709
7710 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7711 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7712 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7713 do {
7714 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7715 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7716 }
7717
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007718 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7719 // the base class indirections.
7720 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7721 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007722 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007723 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7724 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7725 B != BEnd; ++B)
7726 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7727 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007728
7729 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007730 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7731 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7732 unsigned n = Path.size();
7733 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7734 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7735 } else {
7736 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7737 }
7738 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7739 }
7740
7741 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7742 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7743 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7744}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007745
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007746ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007747 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7748 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7749 ParsedType argty,
7750 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7751 unsigned NumComponents,
7752 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7753
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007754 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7755 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7756 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7757 return ExprError();
7758
Eli Friedman5a15dc12010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007759 if (!ArgTInfo)
7760 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7761
7762 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7763 RPLoc);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007764}
7765
7766
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007767ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007768 ParsedType arg1, ParsedType arg2,
7769 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007770 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7771 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7772 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7773 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007774
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007775 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007776
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007777 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7778}
7779
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007780ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007781Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7782 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7783 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7784 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007785 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7786 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7787 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7788 return ExprError();
7789 }
7790
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007791 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007792 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007793}
7794
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007795
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007796ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007797 Expr *CondExpr,
7798 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
7799 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007800 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7801
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007802 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007803 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007804 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007805 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007806 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007807 } else {
7808 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7809 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7810 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7811 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007812 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7813 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7814 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007815
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007816 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7817 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007818 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7819 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007820 }
7821
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007822 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007823 resType, RPLoc,
7824 resType->isDependentType(),
7825 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007826}
7827
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007828//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7829// Clang Extensions.
7830//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7831
7832/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007833void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007834 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7835 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7836 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007837 if (BlockScope)
7838 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7839 else
7840 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007841}
7842
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007843void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007844 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007845 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007846
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007847 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007848 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007849 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007850
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007851 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007852 QualType RetTy;
7853 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007854 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007855 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007856 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007857 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7858 } else {
7859 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007860 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007861 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007862
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007863 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007864
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007865 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7866 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7867 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007868 return;
7869 }
7870
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007871 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7872 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7873 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7874 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7875 return;
7876 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007877
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007878 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007879 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7880 // ^ * { ... }
7881 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007882 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7883 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007884
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007885 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007886 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007887 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7888 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7889 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7890 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007891 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7892 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7893 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7894 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7895 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007896 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007897 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007898
7899 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7900 // ^ fntype { ... }
7901 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7902 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7903 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7904 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7905 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7906 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7907 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007908 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007909 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007910 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007911
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007912 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
Douglas Gregor82aa7132010-11-01 18:37:59 +00007913 if (!Params.empty()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007914 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
Douglas Gregor82aa7132010-11-01 18:37:59 +00007915 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7916 CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(),
7917 /*CheckParameterNames=*/false);
7918 }
7919
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007920 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007921 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007922
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007923 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007924 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7925 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7926 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7927 }
7928
7929 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7930 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007931 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007932 return;
7933
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007934 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7935 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7936
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007937 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007938 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7939 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7940
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007941 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007942 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7943 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7944 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7945
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007946 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007947 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007948 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007949}
7950
7951/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7952/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7953void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007954 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007955 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007956 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007957}
7958
7959/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7960/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007961ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007962 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007963 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7964 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7965 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007966
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007967 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007968
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007969 PopDeclContext();
7970
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007971 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007972 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7973 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007974
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007975 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007976 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007977
7978 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7979 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7980 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7981
7982 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7983 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7984
7985 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7986 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7987 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7988 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7989
7990 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7991 // preserve its sugar structure.
7992 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7993 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7994 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7995
7996 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7997 } else {
7998 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7999 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
8000 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
8001 FPT->getNumArgs(),
8002 FPT->isVariadic(),
8003 /*quals*/ 0,
8004 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
8005 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
8006 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
8007 FPT->exception_begin(),
8008 Ext);
8009 }
8010
8011 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
8012 } else {
8013 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
8014 false, false, 0, 0,
8015 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
8016 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008017
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008018 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
8019 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008020 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008021
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00008022 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00008023 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008024 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008025
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008026 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00008027
8028 bool Good = true;
8029 // Check goto/label use.
8030 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
8031 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8032 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
8033
8034 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
8035 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00008036 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
8037 if (!L->isUsed())
8038 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00008039 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00008040 }
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00008041
8042 // Emit error.
8043 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
8044 Good = false;
8045 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008046 if (!Good) {
8047 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00008048 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008049 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008050
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00008051 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
8052 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
8053
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00008054 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00008055 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
8056 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00008057 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00008058
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008059 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008060 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008061}
8062
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008063ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00008064 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008065 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00008066 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
8067 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008068 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00008069}
8070
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008071ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008072 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00008073 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00008074 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008075
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00008076 // Get the va_list type
8077 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00008078 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
8079 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
8080 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
8081 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00008082 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00008083 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
8084 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
8085 } else {
8086 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
8087 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008088 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00008089 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00008090 return ExprError();
8091 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00008092
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00008093 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
8094 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008095 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
8096 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00008097 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00008098 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008099
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00008100 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00008101 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008102
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00008103 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
8104 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00008105}
8106
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008107ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00008108 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
8109 // pointers on the target.
8110 QualType Ty;
8111 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
8112 Ty = Context.IntTy;
8113 else
8114 Ty = Context.LongTy;
8115
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008116 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00008117}
8118
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008119static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008120 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008121 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
8122 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008123
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008124 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
8125 if (!PT)
8126 return;
8127
8128 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
8129 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
8130 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
8131 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
8132 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
8133 return;
8134 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008135
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008136 // Strip off any parens and casts.
8137 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
8138 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
8139 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008140
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008141 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008142}
8143
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008144bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
8145 SourceLocation Loc,
8146 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00008147 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
8148 bool *Complained) {
8149 if (Complained)
8150 *Complained = false;
8151
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008152 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
8153 bool isInvalid = false;
8154 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008155 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008156
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008157 switch (ConvTy) {
8158 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
8159 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00008160 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008161 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
8162 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00008163 case IntToPointer:
8164 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
8165 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008166 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008167 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008168 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
8169 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00008170 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
8171 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
8172 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008173 case FunctionVoidPointer:
8174 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
8175 break;
8176 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00008177 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
8178 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
8179 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
8180 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
8181 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
8182 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
8183 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
8184 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
8185 // C++ semantics.
8186 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
8187 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
8188 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008189 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
8190 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00008191 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00008192 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00008193 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00008194 case IntToBlockPointer:
8195 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
8196 break;
8197 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00008198 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00008199 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00008200 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008201 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00008202 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
8203 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
8204 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00008205 case IncompatibleVectors:
8206 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
8207 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008208 case Incompatible:
8209 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
8210 isInvalid = true;
8211 break;
8212 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008213
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00008214 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
8215 switch (Action) {
8216 case AA_Assigning:
8217 case AA_Initializing:
8218 // The destination type comes first.
8219 FirstType = DstType;
8220 SecondType = SrcType;
8221 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008222
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00008223 case AA_Returning:
8224 case AA_Passing:
8225 case AA_Converting:
8226 case AA_Sending:
8227 case AA_Casting:
8228 // The source type comes first.
8229 FirstType = SrcType;
8230 SecondType = DstType;
8231 break;
8232 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008233
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00008234 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008235 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00008236 if (Complained)
8237 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008238 return isInvalid;
8239}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008240
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00008241bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00008242 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
8243 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
8244 if (Result)
8245 *Result = ICEResult;
8246 return false;
8247 }
8248
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008249 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
8250
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008251 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008252 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
8253 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
8254
8255 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
8256 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
8257 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
8258 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
8259 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
8260 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
8261 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008262
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008263 return true;
8264 }
8265
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00008266 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
8267 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008268
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00008269 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
8270 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
8271 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008272
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008273 if (Result)
8274 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
8275 return false;
8276}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008277
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008278void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008279Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008280 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
8281 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008282}
8283
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008284void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008285Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
8286 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
8287 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
8288 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008289
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00008290 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
8291 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
8292 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
8293 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
8294 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008295 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00008296 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
8297 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
8298 I != IEnd; ++I)
8299 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
8300 }
8301
8302 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
8303 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
8304 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
8305 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
8306 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
8307 I != IEnd; ++I)
8308 Diag(I->first, I->second);
8309 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008310 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008311
8312 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
8313 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
8314 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
8315 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008316 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008317 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
8318 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
8319 ExprTemporaries.end());
8320
8321 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
8322 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008323}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008324
8325/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
8326///
8327/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
8328/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
8329/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
8330/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
8331///
8332/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
8333///
8334/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
8335void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
8336 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008337
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00008338 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00008339 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008340
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00008341 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
8342 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
8343 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
8344 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008345 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00008346 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +00008347 D->setUsed();
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00008348 return;
8349 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008350
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00008351 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
8352 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008353
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008354 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
8355 // an instantiation.
8356 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
8357 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008358
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008359 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008360 case Unevaluated:
8361 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
8362 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008363
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008364 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
8365 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
8366 // "used"; handle this below.
8367 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008368
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008369 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8370 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
8371 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
8372 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008373 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008374 return;
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008375
8376 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
8377 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
8378 // containing expression is used.
8379 return;
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008380 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008381
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008382 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00008383 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00008384 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00008385 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruth4e6fbce2010-08-23 07:55:51 +00008386 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
8387 return;
8388 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
8389 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008390 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00008391 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00008392 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00008393 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
8394 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008395
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00008396 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00008397 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00008398 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00008399 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00008400 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
8401 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00008402 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
8403 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
8404 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00008405 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00008406 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00008407 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
8408 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00008409 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00008410 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008411 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00008412 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00008413 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008414 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
8415 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
8416 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
8417 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
8418 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008419 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00008420 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008421 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008422 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008423 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
8424 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
8425 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008426 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00008427 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008428 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
8429 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008430
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00008431 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
8432 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
8433 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
8434 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
8435 Loc));
8436 else
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00008437 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00008438 }
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00008439 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
8440 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
8441 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greifbe9ebe32010-08-28 01:58:12 +00008442 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00008443 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
8444 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008445
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008446 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidis58b52592010-08-25 10:34:54 +00008447
8448 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
8449 if (CurContext != Function)
8450 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008451
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008452 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00008453 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008454
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008455 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008456 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008457 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008458 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
8459 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
8460 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
8461 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
8462 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
8463 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00008464 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008465 }
8466 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008467
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008468 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008469
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008470 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008471 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00008472 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008473}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008474
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008475namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008476 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008477 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008478 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008479 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
8480 Sema &S;
8481 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008482
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008483 public:
8484 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008485
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008486 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008487
8488 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
8489 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008490 };
8491}
8492
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008493bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
8494 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008495 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
8496 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
8497 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008498
8499 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008500}
8501
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008502bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008503 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
8504 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
8505 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Douglas Gregor910f8002010-11-07 23:05:16 +00008506 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.data(), Args.size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008507 }
8508
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00008509 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008510}
8511
8512void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
8513 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008514 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008515}
8516
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008517namespace {
8518 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
8519 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8520 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
8521 Sema &S;
8522
8523 public:
8524 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
8525
8526 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
8527
8528 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
8529 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8530 }
8531
8532 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
8533 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008534 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008535 }
8536
8537 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
8538 if (E->getConstructor())
8539 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
8540 if (E->getOperatorNew())
8541 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
8542 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8543 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008544 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008545 }
8546
8547 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
8548 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8549 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00008550 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
8551 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8552 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
8553 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
8554 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
8555 }
8556
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008557 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008558 }
8559
8560 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
8561 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008562 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008563 }
8564
8565 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
8566 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8567 }
Douglas Gregor102ff972010-10-19 17:17:35 +00008568
8569 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
8570 Visit(E->getExpr());
8571 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008572 };
8573}
8574
8575/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
8576/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8577void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
8578 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
8579}
8580
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008581/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
8582/// of the program being compiled.
8583///
8584/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008585/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008586/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
8587/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
8588/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
8589/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008590/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008591/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008592///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008593/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
8594/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
8595/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
8596/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008597bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008598 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
8599 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
8600 case Unevaluated:
8601 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
8602 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008603
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008604 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008605 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008606 Diag(Loc, PD);
8607 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008608
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008609 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8610 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
8611 break;
8612 }
8613
8614 return false;
8615}
8616
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008617bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
8618 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
8619 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
8620 return false;
8621
8622 PartialDiagnostic Note =
8623 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
8624 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
8625 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008626
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008627 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008628 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008629 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
8630 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008631 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008632 << CE->getSourceRange(),
8633 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
8634 return true;
8635
8636 return false;
8637}
8638
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008639// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8640// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8641void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8642 SourceLocation Loc;
8643
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008644 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8645
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008646 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8647 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008648 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008649 return;
8650
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008651 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8652 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8653 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8654 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8655
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008656 // self = [<foo> init...]
8657 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8658 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8659 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8660
8661 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8662 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8663 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8664 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8665 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008666
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008667 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8668 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8669 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8670 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8671 return;
8672
8673 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8674 } else {
8675 // Not an assignment.
8676 return;
8677 }
8678
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008679 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008680 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008681
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008682 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008683 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008684 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008685 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8686 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8687 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008688}
8689
8690bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8691 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8692
8693 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis11ab7902010-11-01 18:49:26 +00008694 if (E->isBoundMemberFunction(Context))
8695 return Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_invalid_use_of_bound_member_func)
8696 << E->getSourceRange();
8697
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008698 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008699
8700 QualType T = E->getType();
8701
8702 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8703 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8704 return true;
8705 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8706 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8707 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8708 return true;
8709 }
8710 }
8711
8712 return false;
8713}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008714
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008715ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8716 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008717 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008718 return ExprError();
8719
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008720 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008721 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008722
8723 return Owned(Sub);
8724}
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008725
8726/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
8727/// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
8728ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8729 const BuiltinType *BT = E->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8730 if (!BT || !BT->isPlaceholderType()) return Owned(E);
8731
8732 // If this is overload, check for a single overload.
8733 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
8734 if (FunctionDecl *Specialization
8735 = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(E)) {
8736 // The access doesn't really matter in this case.
8737 DeclAccessPair Found = DeclAccessPair::make(Specialization,
8738 Specialization->getAccess());
8739 E = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, Found, Specialization);
8740 if (!E) return ExprError();
8741 return Owned(E);
8742 }
8743
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008744 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ovl_unresolvable) << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008745 return ExprError();
8746 }
8747
8748 // Otherwise it's a use of undeduced auto.
8749 assert(BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::UndeducedAuto);
8750
8751 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens());
8752 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
8753 << DRE->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
8754 return ExprError();
8755}